blob: 9bb31e47161385ac362ca92ee06561c11b8aa16a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf0048592021-01-08 21:26:01 +01007 2021/01/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262
2631.2.2. The request headers
264--------------------------
265
266The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
267beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
268an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
269Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
270values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
271encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
272the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
273define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau371ab182020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200278as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
279normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
280representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
281HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
283The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
284that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
285is one valid form of empty line.
286
287Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
288headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
289about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
290application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
291
292Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000293 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
295 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
296 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
297
298
2991.3. HTTP response
300------------------
301
302An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
303messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
304
305 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100306 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
308 2 Content-length: 350
309 3 Content-Type: text/html
310
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200311As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
312codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
313response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100314continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
315the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
316following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
317sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
318(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
319correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
320such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
321state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
322over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
323if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
324information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328------------------------
329
330Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
331
332 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
333 - a status code : 200
334 - a reason : OK
335
336The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100337 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
338 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
339 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
340 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
341 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000343Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100344"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
346messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
347or "Authentication Required".
348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350
351 Code When / reason
352 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
353 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
354 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100356 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
357 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358 400 for an invalid or too large request
359 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
360 accessing the stats page)
361 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
Florian Tham9f3bda02020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100362 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100364 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
365 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
367 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
368 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
369 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
370 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
371 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
372 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
373
374The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3754.2).
376
377
3781.3.2. The response headers
379---------------------------
380
381Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
382the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
383details.
384
385
3862. Configuring HAProxy
387----------------------
388
3892.1. Configuration file format
390------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200391
392HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
393
394 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
395 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
396 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
397 "frontend" and "backend".
398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100399The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
400referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200401delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200403
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004042.2. Quoting and escaping
405-------------------------
406
407HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
408many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
409with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
410single quotes.
411
412If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
413them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
414escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
415
416Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
417
418 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
419 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
420 \\ to use a backslash
421 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
422 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
423
424Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
425the interpretation of:
426
427 space as a parameter separator
428 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
429 # hash as a comment start
430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200431Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
432-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
433backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
434
435Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200436quoting.
437
438Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
439nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
440
441Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
442equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
443
444 Example:
445 # those are equivalents:
446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
448 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
451
452 # those are equivalents:
453 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
457
458
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004592.3. Environment variables
460--------------------------
461
462HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
463interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
464configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
465optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
466shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
467underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
468
469 Example:
470
471 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
472
473 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
474
475 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
476
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200477Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
478file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
481 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
483* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
484 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
485 directory.
486
487* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
488
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500489* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200490 processes, separated by semicolons.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 CLI, separated by semicolons.
494
495See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200496
4972.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200498----------------
499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100500Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100501values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
502otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
503numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
504for every keyword. Supported units are :
505
506 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
507 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
508 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
509 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
510 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
511 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
512
513
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005142.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515-------------
516
517 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
518 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
519 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
520 global
521 daemon
522 maxconn 256
523
524 defaults
525 mode http
526 timeout connect 5000ms
527 timeout client 50000ms
528 timeout server 50000ms
529
530 frontend http-in
531 bind *:80
532 default_backend servers
533
534 backend servers
535 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
536
537
538 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
539 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
540 global
541 daemon
542 maxconn 256
543
544 defaults
545 mode http
546 timeout connect 5000ms
547 timeout client 50000ms
548 timeout server 50000ms
549
550 listen http-in
551 bind *:80
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
556
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100557 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200558
559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005603. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561--------------------
562
563Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
564are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
565of them have command-line equivalents.
566
567The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
568
569 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200570 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - description
576 - deviceatlas-json-file
577 - deviceatlas-log-level
578 - deviceatlas-separator
579 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900580 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - gid
582 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100583 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200584 - h1-case-adjust
585 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua5e11c02020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200668 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
669 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700819 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100826group <group name>
827 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
828 See also "gid" and "user".
829
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100830hard-stop-after <time>
831 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
832
833 Arguments :
834 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
835 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
836 SIGUSR1 signal.
837
838 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
839 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
840 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
841
842 Example:
843 global
844 hard-stop-after 30s
845
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200846h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
847 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
848 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
849 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
850 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500851 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200852 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
853 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
854 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
855 specified in a proxy.
856
857 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
858 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
859 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
860 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
861 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
862 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
863 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
864
865 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
866 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
867 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
868 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
869 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
874
875 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
876 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
877
878h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
879 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
880 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
881 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
882 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
883 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
884 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
885 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
886 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
887
888 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
889 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
890 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200936 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
937 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100938
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200939 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
940 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
941 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
942 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
943 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
944 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
945 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
946 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
947 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
948 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
950 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200951
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200952 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
953 one of the following :
954
955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
957
958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
965 logger consumes.
966
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100967 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
968 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
969 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
970 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
973 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
974 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
975 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
976 set with <sample_size> parameter.
977
978 <sample_size>
979 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
980 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
981 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
982 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
983 (see also <ranges> parameter).
984
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100987 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
988 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
989 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
990
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100991 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
992 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
993 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
994 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995
996 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200997 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
998 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
999 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1000 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1001 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001006log-send-hostname [<string>]
1007 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1008 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1009 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1010 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1011 the logs.
1012
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001013log-tag <string>
1014 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1015 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1016 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001017 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001018
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019lua-load <file>
1020 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1021 used multiple times.
1022
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001023master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001024 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1025 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1026 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001027 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001028 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1029 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001030 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1031 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1032 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1033 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1034 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001035
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001037
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001038mworker-max-reloads <number>
1039 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001040 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1042 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1043 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045nbproc <number>
1046 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1047 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1048 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001049 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1050 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001051 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1052 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001054nbthread <number>
1055 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001056 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1057 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1058 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1059 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1060 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001061 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1062 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1063 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1064 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1065 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1066 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1067 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001070 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1072 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1073
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001074presetenv <name> <value>
1075 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1076 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1077 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1078 and "unsetenv".
1079
1080resetenv [<name> ...]
1081 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1082 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1083 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1084 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1085 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1086 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1087 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1088 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1089
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001090stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001091 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1092 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1093 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1094 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1095 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1096 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001097 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001098 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1099 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1100 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1101 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001102
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001103server-state-base <directory>
1104 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001105 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1106 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001107
1108server-state-file <file>
1109 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1110 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1111 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1112 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1113 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1114 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1115 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1116 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001117 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1118 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001119
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001120setenv <name> <value>
1121 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1122 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1123 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1124 and "unsetenv".
1125
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001126set-dumpable
1127 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1128 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1129 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1130 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1131 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1132 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1133 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1134 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1135 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1136 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1137 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1138 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1139 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1140 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1141 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1142 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1143 expected when dying.
1144
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001145ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1147 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001148 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001149 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001150 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1151 information and recommendations see e.g.
1152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1154 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1155 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001156
1157ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1159 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1160 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1161 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1162 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1164 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1165 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001166 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1171 keyword to see available options.
1172
1173 Example:
1174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1183 information and recommendations see e.g.
1184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001189
1190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1204 keyword to see available options.
1205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1213 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1214 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1215 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001216 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1217 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1218 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1219
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001220ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1221 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1222 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1223 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1224
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001225stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1226 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1227 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1228 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001229 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001230 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001231
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001232 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1233 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1234 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001235
1236stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1237 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1238 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001239 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001240
1241stats maxconn <connections>
1242 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1243 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245uid <number>
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001246 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1248 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1249 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1250
1251ulimit-n <number>
1252 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1253 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1254 option.
1255
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001256unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1257 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1258
1259 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1260 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1261 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1262 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1263 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1264 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1265 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1266 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1267 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1268 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270unsetenv [<name> ...]
1271 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1272 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1273 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1274 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1275 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1276 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1277 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279user <user name>
1280 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1281 See also "uid" and "group".
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001283node <name>
1284 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1285
1286 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1287 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1288 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1289 traffic.
1290
1291description <text>
1292 Add a text that describes the instance.
1293
1294 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1295 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1296 "<" and ">" characters.
1297
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129851degrees-data-file <file path>
1299 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001301
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001302 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1307 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1308 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1309
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001310 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1312
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1315 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
132051degrees-cache-size <number>
1321 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1322 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1323 By default, this cache is disabled.
1324
1325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001328wurfl-data-file <file path>
1329 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1330 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1331
1332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1333 with USE_WURFL=1.
1334
1335wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1336 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1337 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1338 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1339
1340 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1341
1342 Valid WURFL properties are:
1343 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1344
1345 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1346 device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1349 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1350
1351 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1352 particular web request.
1353
1354 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1355 used Libwurfl API version.
1356
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001357 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1358 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1359
1360 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1361 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1362
1363 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1364
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1366 with USE_WURFL=1.
1367
1368wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1369 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1370 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1371
1372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1373 with USE_WURFL=1.
1374
1375wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1376 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1377 thus before the chroot.
1378
1379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1380 with USE_WURFL=1.
1381
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001382wurfl-cache-size <size>
1383 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1384 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001385 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001386 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1389 with USE_WURFL=1.
1390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392-----------------------
1393
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001394busy-polling
1395 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1396 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1397 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1398 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1399 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1400 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1401 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1402 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1403 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1404 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1405 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1406 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1407 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1408 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1409 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1410 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1411 "poll" pollers.
1412
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001413 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1414 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1415 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1416
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001417max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1418 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1419 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1420 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1421 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1422 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1423 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1424 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1425 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427maxconn <number>
1428 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1429 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1430 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001431 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1432 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1433 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1434 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001435 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1436 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1437 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1438 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1439 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1440 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001442maxconnrate <number>
1443 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1444 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1445 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1446 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1447 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1448 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1449 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1450 fairness.
1451
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452maxcomprate <number>
1453 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1456 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1457 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001459 default value.
1460
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001461maxcompcpuusage <number>
1462 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1463 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1464 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1465 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1466 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1467 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1468 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1469 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1470
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001471maxpipes <number>
1472 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1473 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1474 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1475 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1476 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1477 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1478
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001479maxsessrate <number>
1480 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1481 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1482 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1483 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1484 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1485 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1486 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1487 fairness.
1488
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001489maxsslconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1491 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1492 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1493 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1494 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1495 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1496 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001497 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1498 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1499 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1500 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1501 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1502 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1503 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001504
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001505maxsslrate <number>
1506 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1507 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1508 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1509 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1510 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1511 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1512 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1513 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1514 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1515 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1516
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001517maxzlibmem <number>
1518 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1519 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1520 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001521 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1522 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1523 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525noepoll
1526 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1527 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001528 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529
1530nokqueue
1531 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1532 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1533 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1534
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001535noevports
1536 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1537 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1538 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1539 also "nopoll".
1540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541nopoll
1542 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1543 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001545 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1546 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548nosplice
1549 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1554 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1555 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1556 "option splice-response".
1557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558nogetaddrinfo
1559 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1560 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1561
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001562noreuseport
1563 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1564 command line argument "-dR".
1565
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001566profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1567 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1568 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1569 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1570 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001571 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001572 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1573 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1574 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1575 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1576
1577 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1578 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1579 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1580 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1581 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001582 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1583 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1584 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1585 CLI.
1586
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001587spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001588 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1589 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1590 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1591 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1592 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1593 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001596 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1599 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1600 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1601 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1602 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1604 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001605 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1606 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1607 openssl configuration file uses:
1608 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1609
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001610ssl-mode-async
1611 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001612 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001613 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1614 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1615 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001616 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001617 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001618
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001619tune.buffers.limit <number>
1620 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1621 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1622 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1623 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1624 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001626 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1627 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1628 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1629 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1630 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1631 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1632 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1633 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1634 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1635
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001636tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1637 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1638 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1639 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1640 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1641
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001642tune.bufsize <number>
1643 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1644 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1645 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1646 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1647 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1648 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1649 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001650 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1651 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1652 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001653 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001654 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1655 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1656 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001657
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001658tune.chksize <number>
1659 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1660 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1661 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1662 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1663 checks whenever possible.
1664
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001665tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1666 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1667 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1668 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1669 this value. The default value is 1.
1670
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001671tune.fail-alloc
1672 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1673 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1674 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1675 gracefully.
1676
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001677tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1678 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1679 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1680 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1681 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1682 change it.
1683
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001684tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1685 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1687 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001688 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1689 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1690 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1691 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1692 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1693
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001694tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1695 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1696 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1697 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1698 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1699 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1700 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1701 recommended not to change this value.
1702
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001703tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1704 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1705 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1706 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1707 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1708 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1709 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1710 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1711
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001712tune.http.cookielen <number>
1713 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1714 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1715 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1716 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1717 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1718 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1719 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1720 to change this value.
1721
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1724 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 configuration directives too.
1728 The default value is 1024.
1729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1738 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1739 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001740
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001741tune.idletimer <timeout>
1742 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1743 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1744 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1745 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1746 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1747 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001749 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001750 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1751
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001752tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1754 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1755 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1756 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1757 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1758 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1759 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1760 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1761 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1762
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1764 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001765 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1767 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1770 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1771
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001772tune.lua.maxmem
1773 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1774 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1775 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1776 memory.
1777
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1779 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001780 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1781 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001783
1784tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1785 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1786 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1787 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1788 check servers.
1789
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001790tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1791 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1792 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1793 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001795
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001796tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001797 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1798 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1799 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1800 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1801 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1802 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1803 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1804 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1805 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1806 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807
1808tune.maxpollevents <number>
1809 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1810 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1811 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1812 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1813 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1814
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001815tune.maxrewrite <number>
1816 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1817 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1818 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1819 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1820 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1821 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1822 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1823 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1824 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1825 bufsize.
1826
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001827tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1828 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1829 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1830 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1831 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1832 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1833 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1834 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1835 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1836 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001837 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1838 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001839 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1840 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1841 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1842 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1843 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1844 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1845 setting this parameter to 0.
1846
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001847tune.pipesize <number>
1848 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1849 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1850 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1851 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1852 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1853 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1854
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001855tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1857 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1858 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1859 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1860 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1861 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001862 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc55e3e12020-07-01 18:30:16 +02001864tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1868 default is 20.
1869
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001870tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1871tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1872 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1873 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1874 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001875 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001877 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1878 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1879
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001880tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001882 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1883 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1884 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1885 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1886
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001887tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001888 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001889 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1890 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1893tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1895 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1902 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1903 notifying haproxy again.
1904
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001905tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001906 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1907 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1908 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001910 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001911 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001912 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1913 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1914 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001915 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1916 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001917
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001918tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001919 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001920 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1921 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1922 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1923 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1924 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1925
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1927 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001928 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1930 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1931 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1932 being used for too long.
1933
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001934tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1935 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1936 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1937 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1938 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1939 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1940 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1941 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1942 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1943 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1944 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001946 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001947
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001948tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1949 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1950 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1951 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1952 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1953 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1954 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1955 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1957 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001959tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1960 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1961 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1962 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1963 1000 entries.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001965tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1966 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1967 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1968 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001970tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001971tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001972tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1973tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001975 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1976 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1977 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1978 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1979 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1980 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1981 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1982 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001984 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1985 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1986 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1987 all available space is consumed.
1988 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1989 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1990 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1998
1999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020053.3. Debugging
2006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
2008debug
2009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2012 system startup.
2013
2014quiet
2015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2016 line argument "-q".
2017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020193.4. Userlists
2020--------------
2021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2024
2025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2028
2029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2040 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2041 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002043 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2044 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2045 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2046 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2047 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2048 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2049 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2050 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2051 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
2053 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002054 userlist L1
2055 group G1 users tiger,scott
2056 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002058 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2059 user scott insecure-password elgato
2060 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002062 userlist L2
2063 group G1
2064 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2067 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2068 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069
2070 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
20733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002074----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002075It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2076several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2077instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2078values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2079automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2080In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2081using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2082tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2083reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2084Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2085that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2086each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087
2088peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002089 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2091
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002092bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2093 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2094 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2095
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002096disabled
2097 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2098 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2099 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2100
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002101default-bind [param*]
2102 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2103
2104default-server [param*]
2105 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2106
2107 Arguments:
2108 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2109 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2110 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2111 details.
2112
2113
2114 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2115
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002116enable
2117 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2118
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002119peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002120 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2121 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2122 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2123 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2124 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2125 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2126
2127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2129
2130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2132 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2133 across all peers.
2134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2139 "server" keyword explanation below).
2140
2141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2146 of this "peers" section).
2147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2148
2149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156
2157 backend mybackend
2158 mode tcp
2159 balance roundrobin
2160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2161 stick on src
2162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Example:
2167 peers mypeers
2168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2169 default-server ssl verify none
2170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002173
2174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2176
2177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2182 "stick-table" keyword).
2183
2184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2190 of the stick-table name as follows:
2191
2192 peers mypeers
2193 peer A ...
2194 peer B ...
2195 table t1 ...
2196
2197 frontend fe1
2198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2199
2200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2202
2203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2210
2211 peers mypeers
2212 peer A ...
2213 peer B ...
2214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2215
2216 backend t1
2217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2218
2219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022233.6. Mailers
2224------------
2225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2232
2233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2235
2236 Example:
2237 mailers mymailers
2238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2240
2241 backend mybackend
2242 mode tcp
2243 balance roundrobin
2244
2245 email-alert mailers mymailers
2246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2248
2249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002252timeout mail <time>
2253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 mailers mymailers
2260 timeout mail 20s
2261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022633.7. Programs
2264-------------
2265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2267managed the same way as the workers.
2268
2269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2270sequence as a worker:
2271
2272 - the master is re-executed
2273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2275 instance of the program
2276
2277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2278
2279program <name>
2280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2282 the management guide).
2283
2284command <command> [arguments*]
2285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2289
2290option start-on-reload
2291no option start-on-reload
2292 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2293 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2294 program section.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002298----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002301 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002302 - frontend <name>
2303 - backend <name>
2304 - listen <name>
2305
2306A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2307its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2308section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
2311A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2312connections.
2313
2314A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2315to forward incoming connections.
2316
2317A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2318parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2321'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2322case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2323
2324Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2325logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2326proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2327However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2328name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2329
2330Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2331and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2334modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2335arbitrary criteria.
2336
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2338a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002339the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340
2341 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2342 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2343 between responses and new requests.
2344
2345 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2346 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2347 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002348 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2349 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2350 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2351 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2354 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2355 client-facing connection remains open.
2356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2358 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2361frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2362following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002363weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002365 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2368 ----+-----+-----+----
2369 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2370 ----+-----+-----+----
2371 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2372 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2373 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2374 ----+-----+-----+----
2375 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2380--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002382The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2383limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2384they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2385limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002387option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002388and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2389with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2390specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2394------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2395acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396backlog X X X -
2397balance X - X X
2398bind - X X -
2399bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002400block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401capture cookie - X X -
2402capture request header - X X -
2403capture response header - X X -
2404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002408declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409default-server X - X X
2410default_backend X X X -
2411description - X X X
2412disabled X X X X
2413dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002414email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002415email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002416email-alert mailers X X X X
2417email-alert myhostname X X X X
2418email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419enabled X X X X
2420errorfile X X X X
2421errorloc X X X X
2422errorloc302 X X X X
2423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2424errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002425force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002426filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427fullconn X - X X
2428grace X X X X
2429hash-type X - X X
2430http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002432http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002434http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002435http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002436http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002438ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002439load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002440log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002441log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002442log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002443log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002444max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445maxconn X X X -
2446mode X X X X
2447monitor fail - X X -
2448monitor-net X X X -
2449monitor-uri X X X -
2450option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2451option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2452option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2453option allbackups (*) X - X X
2454option checkcache (*) X - X X
2455option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2456option contstats (*) X X X -
2457option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2458option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2460option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002463option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002464option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002465option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002466option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002467option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002469option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002471option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472option httpchk X - X X
2473option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002474option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002475option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002476option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002477option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002478option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2480option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2481option logasap (*) X X X -
2482option mysql-check X - X X
2483option nolinger (*) X X X X
2484option originalto X X X X
2485option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002486option pgsql-check X - X X
2487option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002488option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002489option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490option smtpchk X - X X
2491option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2492option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2493option splice-request (*) X X X X
2494option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002495option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2497option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2498-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002499option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2501option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2502option tcpka X X X X
2503option tcplog X X X X
2504option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002505external-check command X - X X
2506external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2508rate-limit sessions X X X -
2509redirect - X X X
2510redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2511redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002512reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2513reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002524-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002525reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002527retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002528rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2529rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2534rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002536server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002537server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002538source X - X X
2539srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002540stats admin - X X X
2541stats auth X X X X
2542stats enable X X X X
2543stats hide-version X X X X
2544stats http-request - X X X
2545stats realm X X X X
2546stats refresh X X X X
2547stats scope X X X X
2548stats show-desc X X X X
2549stats show-legends X X X X
2550stats show-node X X X X
2551stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2553stick match - - X X
2554stick on - - X X
2555stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002556stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002557stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002558tcp-check connect - - X X
2559tcp-check expect - - X X
2560tcp-check send - - X X
2561tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002562tcp-request connection - X X -
2563tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002564tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002565tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002566tcp-response content - - X X
2567tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568timeout check X - X X
2569timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002570timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2572timeout connect X - X X
2573timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2574timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2575timeout http-request X X X X
2576timeout queue X - X X
2577timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002578timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2580timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002581timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002583unique-id-format X X X -
2584unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002586use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002587------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2588 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2592---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
2594This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2595
2596
2597acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2598 Declare or complete an access list.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 no | yes | yes | yes
2601 Example:
2602 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2603 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2604 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
2608
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002609backlog <conns>
2610 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | no
2613 Arguments :
2614 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2615 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002616 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002617
2618 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2619 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2620 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2621 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2622 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2623 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2624 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2625 backlog parameter.
2626
2627 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2628 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2629 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2630
2631 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2632
2633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002635balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | no | yes | yes
2639 Arguments :
2640 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2641 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2642 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2643 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2644
2645 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2646 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2647 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2648 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002649 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002650 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002651 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2652 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2653 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2654 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2655 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2656 it, so that you don't worry.
2657
2658 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2659 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2660 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2661 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2662 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2663 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2664 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2665 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002667 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2668 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2669 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2670 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2671 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2672 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2673 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2674 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2675
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002676 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002678 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2679 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002680 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002681 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2682 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2683 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2684 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2685 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002686 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2687 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2688 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2689 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2690 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2691 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2695 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2696 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2697 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2698 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2699 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2700 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002701 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002703 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2704 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2705 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002707 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2708 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2709 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2710 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2711 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2712 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2713 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2714 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2715 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2716 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2717 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2718 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002720 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002721 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2722 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2723 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2724 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2725 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2726 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2727 URIs start with a leading "/".
2728
2729 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2730 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2731 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2732 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002735 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2736
2737 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002738 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2739 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002740 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2741 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2742 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2743 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002745 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2746 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002747
2748 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2749 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2750 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2751 server will receive the request.
2752
2753 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2754 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2755 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2756 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2757 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002758 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2759 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2760 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002762 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2763 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2764 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2765 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2766 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002768 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002769 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2770 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2771 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2772
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002773 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2774 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2775 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2776
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002777 random
2778 random(<draws>)
2779 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002780 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2781 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2782 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2783 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002784 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2785 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2786 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2787 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2788 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2789 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2790 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2791 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2792 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2793 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2794 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2795 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2796 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2797 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2798 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2799 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2800 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2801 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2802 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2803 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002804
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002805 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002806 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002807 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2808 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2809 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2810 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2811 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2812 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002813 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002814 used instead.
2815
2816 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2817 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2818 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2819 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2820
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002821 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2822 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2823 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2824
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002825 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002828 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2829 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002830
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002831 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2832 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2833 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002835 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002836 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002837 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2838 NTLM relies on.
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840 Examples :
2841 balance roundrobin
2842 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002844 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2845 balance hdr(host)
2846 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847
2848 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2849 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002851 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2853 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2854 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2855 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2856
2857 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2858 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2859 defaults to 16 kB.
2860
2861 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2862 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2863
2864 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2865 Round Robin.
2866
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002867 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002868 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2869 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2870 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2871
2872 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2873
2874 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002876 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2877 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2878 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002880 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
2882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002883bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2884bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002889 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2890 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2891 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2892 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002893 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002894 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2895 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2896 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2897 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2902 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2903 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2904 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2905 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2906 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2907 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002908 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2909 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2910 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002911 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2912 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2913 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2914 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002915 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2916 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2917 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002918
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002919 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2920 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002921 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2922 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2923 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002924 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2925 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2926 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2927 the range.
2928
2929 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2930 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2931 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2932 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2933 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2934 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2935 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002936 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002937 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002939 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002940 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002941 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2942 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2943 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2944 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2945 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2946 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002948 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2949 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2950 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2951 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2954 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2955 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2956 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2957 in a frontend.
2958
2959 Example :
2960 listen http_proxy
2961 bind :80,:443
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002963 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002965 listen http_https_proxy
2966 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002967 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002969 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2970 bind ipv6@:80
2971 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2972 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2973
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002974 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002975 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002976
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002977 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2978 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2979 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2980 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2981 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985
2986
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002987bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002988 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991 Arguments :
2992 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2993 may be used to override a default value.
2994
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002995 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002996 option may be combined with other numbers.
2997
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002998 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002999 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3000 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3001 missing from all processes.
3002
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003003 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003004 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003005 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3006 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3007 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3008 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3009 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003010 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003011
3012 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3013 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3014 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3015 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3016 and 'even' instances.
3017
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003018 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3019 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3020 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3021 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003022
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003023 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3024 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3025
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003026 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3027 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3028 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3029
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3031 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3032
3033 Example :
3034 listen app_ip1
3035 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen app_ip2
3039 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
3042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003044 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003045
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003046 listen management
3047 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3048 bind-process 1-4
3049
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003050 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003051
3052
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003053block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3059 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003060 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003061 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003063 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3064 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3065 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003067 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3068 "http-request deny" instead.
3069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Example:
3071 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3072 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3073 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003074 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3075 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3076 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003078 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3079 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3080 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081
3082capture cookie <name> len <length>
3083 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
3087 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3088 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3089 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3090 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
3093 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3094 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3095 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3096 right if it exceeds <length>.
3097
3098 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3099 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3100 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3101 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3102
3103 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3104 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3105 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3106
3107 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3108 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3109 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003110 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3111 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3112 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113
3114 Example:
3115 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3116
3117 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
3120
3121capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003122 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments :
3126 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003127 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3129 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3130 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3131
3132 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3133 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3134 it exceeds <length>.
3135
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003136 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3138 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003139 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3140 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3141 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3142 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003143 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003144 environments to find where the request came from.
3145
3146 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3147 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3148 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3149 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003151 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3152 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3153 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3154 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3155 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
3157 Example:
3158 capture request header Host len 15
3159 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003160 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163 about logging.
3164
3165
3166capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003167 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 no | yes | yes | no
3170 Arguments :
3171 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003172 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3174 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3175 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3176
3177 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3178 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3179 it exceeds <length>.
3180
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003181 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3183 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3184 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003185 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3186 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3187 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3188 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003190 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3191 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3192 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3193 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3194 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
3196 Example:
3197 capture response header Content-length len 9
3198 capture response header Location len 15
3199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003200 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 about logging.
3202
3203
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003204clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3211 as explained at the top of this document.
3212
3213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3217 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3218 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3219 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3220 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003221 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003223 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3226 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3227 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3228 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3229 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3230 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3231
3232 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3233 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3234
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003235 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3236 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003238compression algo <algorithm> ...
3239compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003240compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003241 Enable HTTP compression.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3246 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3247 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3248
3249 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003250 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3251 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3252 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003254 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003255 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003256
3257 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3258 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3259 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3260 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3261 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003262 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003263
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003264 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3265 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3266 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3267 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3268 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3269 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3270 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003271 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003272
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003273 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003274 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003275 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3276 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3277 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3278 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3279 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003280
3281 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3282 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3283 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3284 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3285 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003286 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3287 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3288 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3289 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3290 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003291 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3292 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003293
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003294 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003295 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3296 "Accept-Encoding" header
3297 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003298 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003299 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3300 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3301 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3302 "multipart"
3303 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3304 header
3305 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3306 and later
3307 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3308 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003309 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003310
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003311 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003312
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003313 Examples :
3314 compression algo gzip
3315 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003317
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003318contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | no | yes | yes
3322 Arguments :
3323 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3325 as explained at the top of this document.
3326
3327 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003328 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003329 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3332 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3333 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3334
3335 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3337 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3338 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3339 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3340 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3341
3342 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3343 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3344 instead.
3345
3346 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3347 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3348
3349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003350cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003351 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3352 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003353 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357 Arguments :
3358 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3359 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3360 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3361 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3362 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3363 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3366 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3367
3368 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3369 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3370 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3371 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3372 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3373 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003374 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3375 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003377 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3378 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
3380 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003381 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003382
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003383 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003385 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3388 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3389 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3390 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3391 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3392 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3393 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394
3395 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3396 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3397 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3398 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3399 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3400 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3401 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3402 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3403 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003404 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003405 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3406 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3407 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003409 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3410 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3411 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003412 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3413 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3414 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3415 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003416 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3417 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3418 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3421 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3422 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3423 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3424 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3425 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3426 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3427 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3428 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3429
3430 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3431 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3432 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3433 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3434 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3435 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3436 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3437 persistence cookie in the cache.
3438 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3439
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003440 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3441 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3442 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3443 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3444 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003446 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3447 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3448 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3449 they logout.
3450
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003451 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3452 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3453 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3454 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3455
3456 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3457 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3458 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3459 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3460 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3461 this attribute.
3462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003463 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003464 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003465 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3466 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3467 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3468 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3469 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3470 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003471
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003472 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3473 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3474 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3475 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3476 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3477 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3478 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3479 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003480 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003481 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3482 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3483 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3484 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3485 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3486 the site.
3487
3488 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3489 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3490 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3491 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3492 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3493 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3494 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3495 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3496 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3497 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3498 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3499 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3500 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003501 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003502 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3503 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3504
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003505 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3506 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3507 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3508 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3509 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3510 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3511
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003512 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3513 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3514 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3515 repeated.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3518 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3519 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3520 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 Examples :
3523 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3524 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3525 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003526 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003528 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003530
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003531declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3532 Declares a capture slot.
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 no | yes | yes | no
3535 Arguments:
3536 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3537
3538 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3539 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3540 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3541 for use in the response.
3542
3543 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003544 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003545 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3546
3547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003548default-server [param*]
3549 Change default options for a server in a backend
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003553 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3554 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3555 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3556 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003557
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003558 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003559 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3560
3561 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564default_backend <backend>
3565 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | no
3568 Arguments :
3569 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3570
3571 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3572 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3573 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3574 will catch all undetermined requests.
3575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576 Example :
3577
3578 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3579 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3580 default_backend dynamic
3581
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003582 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003585description <string>
3586 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3588 no | yes | yes | yes
3589 Arguments : string
3590
3591 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3592 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3593 it describes.
3594 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3595
3596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003597disabled
3598 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3604 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3605 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3606 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3607 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3608 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3609 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3610
3611 See also : "enabled"
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614dispatch <address>:<port>
3615 Set a default server address
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003619
3620 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3621 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3622 during start-up.
3623
3624 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3625 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3626 possible with normal servers.
3627
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003628 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003629 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3630 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3631 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3632 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3633
3634 See also : "server"
3635
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003636
3637dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3638 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
3641 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3642
3643 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003644 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003645 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3646 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003648 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650enabled
3651 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments : none
3655
3656 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3657 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3658
3659 See also : "disabled"
3660
3661
3662errorfile <code> <file>
3663 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666 Arguments :
3667 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003668 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3669 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670
3671 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003672 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003674 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3675 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
3677 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3678 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3679 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3680
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003681 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3684 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3685 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3686 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3689 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003690 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3692 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3693 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3696 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3697 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003698 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3700
3701 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3702
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003703 Example :
3704 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003705 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003706 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3707 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709
3710errorloc <code> <url>
3711errorloc302 <code> <url>
3712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments :
3716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003717 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3718 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003719
3720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725
3726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3734 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3735 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003736 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3738 request.
3739
3740 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3741
3742
3743errorloc303 <code> <url>
3744 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | yes | yes | yes
3747 Arguments :
3748 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003749 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3750 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751
3752 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3753 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3754 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3755 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757
3758 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3759 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3760 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3761
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003762 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3765 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3766 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3767 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003768 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3771
3772
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773email-alert from <emailaddr>
3774 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003775 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778
3779 Arguments :
3780
3781 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3782
3783 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3784 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003786 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3788 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003789
3790
3791email-alert level <level>
3792 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3793 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796
3797 Arguments :
3798
3799 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3800 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3801 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3802
3803 By default level is alert
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3806 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3807 for the proxy.
3808
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003809 Alerts are sent when :
3810
3811 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3812 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3813 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3814 is notice or lower
3815 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3816 and a health check status update occurs
3817
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003818 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3819 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003820 section 3.6 about mailers.
3821
3822
3823email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3824 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827
3828 Arguments :
3829
3830 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3831
3832 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3833 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3834
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003835 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3836 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003837
3838
3839email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3840 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3841 mailers.
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844
3845 Arguments :
3846
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003847 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003848
3849 By default the systems hostname is used.
3850
3851 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3852 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3853 for the proxy.
3854
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003855 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3856 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857
3858
3859email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | yes
3864
3865 Arguments :
3866
3867 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3868
3869 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3870 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3871
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003872 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003873 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3877 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003879 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
3881 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3882 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3883 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3884 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3885 marked down for maintenance operations.
3886
3887 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3888 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3889 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3890 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3891 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3892 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3893 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3894 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3895 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3896
3897 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3898 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3899 is used.
3900
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003901 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003902 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003903
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003904
3905filter <name> [param*]
3906 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | yes
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3911 referenced in section 9.
3912
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003913 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003914 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003915 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3916 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3919 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3920
3921 Example:
3922 listen
3923 bind *:80
3924
3925 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3926 filter compression
3927 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3928
3929 compression algo gzip
3930 compression offload
3931
3932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3933
3934 See also : section 9.
3935
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937fullconn <conns>
3938 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments :
3942 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3943 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3944
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003945 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003947 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3949 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3950 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3951 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3952 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003953 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003955 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3956 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003957 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3958 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3959 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 Example :
3962 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3963 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3964 # connections.
3965 backend dynamic
3966 fullconn 10000
3967 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3968 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969
3970 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3971
3972
3973grace <time>
3974 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977 Arguments :
3978 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3979 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3980 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3981
3982 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3983 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3986
3987 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3988 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3989 simplify it.
3990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003992hash-balance-factor <factor>
3993 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | no | yes
3996 Arguments :
3997 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3998 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003999 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004000
4001 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4002 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4003 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4004 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4005 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4006 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4007 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4008
4009 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4010 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4011 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4012 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4013 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4014
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004015 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4016 consistent hashing mechanism.
4017
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004018 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4019
4020
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004021hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004026 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4027 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004029 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4030 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4031 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4032 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4033 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4034 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4035 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4036 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4037 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4038 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4041 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4042 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4043 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4044 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4045 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4046 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4047 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4048 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4049 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4050 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4051 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4052 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004053 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4054 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004055
4056 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004058 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004059 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4060 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4061 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004062 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4063 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4064 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004065
4066 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4067 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004068 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4069 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4070 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4071 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4072
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004073 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4074 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4075 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4076 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4077 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4078 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4079 parameter.
4080
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004081 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4082 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4083 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4084 used on strings.
4085
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004086 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4087
4088 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4089 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4090 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4091 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4092 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4093 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4094 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4095 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4096 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4097 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4098 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4099 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004100
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004101 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4102 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4103 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004104
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004105 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004106
4107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108http-check disable-on-404
4109 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Arguments : none
4113
4114 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4115 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4116 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4117 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4118 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4119 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4120 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4121 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004122 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4123 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4124 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4125
4126 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4127
4128
4129http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004130 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004133 Arguments :
4134 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4135 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004136 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004137 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4138 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4139 details on the supported keywords.
4140
4141 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4142 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4143 with the usual backslash ('\').
4144
4145 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4146 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4147 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4148 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4149 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4150
4151 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004152 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004153 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4154 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4155 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4156
4157 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004159 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4160 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4161 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4162 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4163
4164 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4167 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4169 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4170 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004171 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 trace).
4173
4174 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004176 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4177 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4178 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4179 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4180 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004181 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004182
4183 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4184 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4185 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4186 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4187 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4188 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4189 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4190 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4191
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004192 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4193 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4194 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4195
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004196 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4197 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004201 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004202
4203 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004204 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004205
4206 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004207 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208
4209 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004210 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004212 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213
4214
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004215http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4216 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4217 health checks.
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments :
4221 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4222 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4223 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4224
4225 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4226 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4227 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4228 to the request.
4229
4230 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4231 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4232 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4233 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4234 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4235 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4236 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4237 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4238
4239 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4240
4241
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004242http-check send-state
4243 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | no | yes | yes
4246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4249 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4250 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4251 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4252 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4253
4254 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4255 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4256 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4257 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4258 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004259 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4260 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4261 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4262
4263 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4264 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4265 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4266
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004267 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4268 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4269 checked in multiple backends.
4270
4271 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4272 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4273
4274 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4275 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4276 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4277 one fails.
4278
4279 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4280 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4281 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4282
4283 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4284 server's queue.
4285
4286 Example of a header received by the application server :
4287 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4288 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4289
4290 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292
4293http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004294 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4295
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 no | yes | yes | yes
4298
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4300 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4301 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4302 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4303 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4306 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4311 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4312 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4313 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4316 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4317 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4318 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 Example:
4321 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4322 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4323 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 http-request allow if nagios
4326 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4327 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Example:
4331 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4332 acl add path /addacl
4333 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4338 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 Example:
4341 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4342 acl setmap path /setmap
4343 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4348 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4351 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4356 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4357 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4358 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4359 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4360 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4361 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4362 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4367 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4369 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4370 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4371 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4372 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4373 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4378 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004379
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4384 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4385 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4386 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4387 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 Example:
4390 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4391 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004392
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004393http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4401 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4402 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4403 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4404 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4405 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4406 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4407 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4408 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4411 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4412 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004413 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4414
4415 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4416 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4417 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4418 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4423 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4424 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4425 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4426 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4427 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4436 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4437 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4438 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4439 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4440 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4445 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4446 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4447 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4448 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004449
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004450http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4451 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4452 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4453 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4454
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004455http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4456
4457 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4458 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4459 pointed by <resolvers>.
4460 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4461 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4462 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4463 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4464 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4465 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4466 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4467 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4468 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4469 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4470 to 0.0.0.0.
4471
4472 Example:
4473 resolvers mydns
4474 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4475 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4476 timeout retry 1s
4477 hold valid 10s
4478 hold nx 3s
4479 hold other 3s
4480 hold obsolete 0s
4481 accepted_payload_size 8192
4482
4483 frontend fe
4484 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4485 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4486 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4487
4488 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4489 # which mean DNS resolution error
4490 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4491
4492 default_backend be
4493
4494 backend b_503
4495 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4496 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4497 # 503 error page to end users
4498
4499 backend be
4500 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4501 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4502 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4503 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4504 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4505
4506 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4507 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4508
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004509http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510
4511 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4512 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4513 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4514 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004515 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4516 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004517
4518 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4523 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4524 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4525 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4526 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4531 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4532 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4533 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004537
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004538 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4540 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4541 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4542 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4543 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4546 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4547 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4548 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4549 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004550
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004551 Example:
4552 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4553
4554 # applied to:
4555 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4556
4557 # outputs:
4558 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4559
4560 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004561
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004562 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4563
4564 # applied to:
4565 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004566
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004567 # outputs:
4568 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004570http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4574 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet99721282020-09-02 14:16:59 +02004575 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
4576 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
4577 query-string.
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004578
4579 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4580 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4581 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4582
4583 Example:
4584 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4585 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4586
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004587 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4588 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4589 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4590 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4591
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004592http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4593 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4594
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004595 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4596 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4597 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4598 against.
4599
4600 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4601 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4602 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004603
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004604 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4605 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4606 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4607 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4608 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4609 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4610 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4611 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4612 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004613 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4614 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004615
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004616 Example:
4617 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4618 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004619
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004620 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4621 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4624 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004625
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004626 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4627 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4628 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4629 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004630
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004631 Example:
4632 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004633
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004634 # applied to:
4635 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004636
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004637 # outputs:
4638 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4641http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4644 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4645 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4650 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4651 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4656 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4657 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4658 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4659 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 Arguments:
4662 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4663 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 Example:
4666 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4667 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4670 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4675 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4676 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678 Arguments:
4679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4680 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 Example:
4683 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4684 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4687 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4688 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4693 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4694 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4695 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4696 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 Example:
4699 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4700 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4701 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4702 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4712 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4713 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4714 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4715 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4721 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4722 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4723 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4724 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4725 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4726 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4727 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4728 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004730http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004732 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4733 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4734 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4735 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4736 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4737 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4738 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004740http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4743 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4744 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4749 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4750 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4751 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4752 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4753 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4754 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4755 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4760 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4761 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4762 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4763 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4764 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004766 Example :
4767 # prepend the host name before the path
4768 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004772 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4773 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4774 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4775 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4776 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004780 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4781 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4782 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4783 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4784 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4785 values have higher priority.
4786 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4787 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4788 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4789 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4790 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004792http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4795 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4796 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4797 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4798 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4799 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4800 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004802 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004803
4804 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4806 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004808http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4810 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4811 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004812 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4813 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814
4815 Arguments :
4816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4817 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004818
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004819 See also "option forwardfor".
4820
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004821 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4823 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4824
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004825 # After the masking this will track connections
4826 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4827 http-request track-sc0 src
4828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004829 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4830 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4831
4832http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4833
4834 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4835 expression.
4836
4837 Arguments:
4838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4839 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004840
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004841 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004842 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4843 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4844
4845 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4846 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4847 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4848
4849http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4850
4851 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4852 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4853 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4854 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4855 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4856 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4857 information from the request.
4858
4859 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4860
4861http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4862
4863 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4864 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4865 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4866 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4867 path and the query string.
4868 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4869
4870http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4871
4872 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4873 inline.
4874
4875 Arguments:
4876 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4877 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4881 (request and response)
4882 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4883 processing
4884 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4885 processing
4886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4887 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4888 and '_'.
4889
4890 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4891 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004892
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004893 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004894 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4900 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4901 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4902 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4903 agent name must be used.
4904
4905 Arguments:
4906 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4907
4908 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4909 configuration.
4910
4911http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4912
4913 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4914 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4915 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4916 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4917 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4918 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4919 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4920 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4921 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4922 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4923 action.
4924 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4925 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4926 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4927 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4928 you fully understand how it works.
4929
4930http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4933 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4934 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4935 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4936 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4937 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4938 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4939 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4940 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4941 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4942 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4943 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4944 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4945
4946http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4947http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949
4950 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4951 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4952 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4953 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4954 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4955 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4956 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4957 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4958 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4959 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4960 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4961 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4962
4963 Arguments :
4964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4965 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4966 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4967 select which table entry to update the counters.
4968
4969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4970 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4971 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4972 that table until the session ends.
4973
4974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4975 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4976 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4977 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4978 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4979 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4980 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4981 useful information.
4982
4983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4984 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4985 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4986 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4987 checks that make use of it.
4988
4989http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
4993 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004996http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4999 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5000 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5001 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5002 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5003 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5004
5005 Arguments :
5006 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005011http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5014 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5015 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005019 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5020
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5025 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5026 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5027 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5028 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5029 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5032 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5037 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5038 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5039 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5042 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5043 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5044 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 Example:
5047 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5052 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 Example:
5055 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5060 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5063 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5068 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5069 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5070 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5071 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5072 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5073 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5074 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5079 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5080 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5081 example, or to pass some internal information.
5082 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5083 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5084 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005086http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5089 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005091http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005093 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5098 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5099 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5100 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5101 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5102 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5103 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5106 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5107 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5108 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5109 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005110
5111 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5112 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5113 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5114 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5122 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5123 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005138http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5141 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5146 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5147 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5148 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5149 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5150 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005152http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005154
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005155 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5156 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005158 Example:
5159 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161 # applied to:
5162 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 # outputs:
5165 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005171
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005172 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5173 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175 Example:
5176 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005178 # applied to:
5179 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 # outputs:
5182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5188 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5189 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5194 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5195 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005197http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005199 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5200 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5201 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5202 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5203 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 Arguments:
5206 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5209 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5214 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5215 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005217http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5218
5219 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5220 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5221 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5222 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5223 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5224
5225http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5226
5227 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5228 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5229 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5230 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5231 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5232 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5233 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5234 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5235 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5236
5237http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5238
5239 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5240 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5241 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5242 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5243 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5244 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5245 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5246
5247http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5248
5249 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5254 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5255 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5256 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5257
5258http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5260
5261 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5262 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5263 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5264 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005265
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005266 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005267 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5268 http-response set-status 431
5269 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5270 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005272http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5275 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5276 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5277 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5278 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5279 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5280 based on some information from the request.
5281
5282 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5283
5284http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005306
5307 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005308 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005310http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005312 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5313 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5314 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5315 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5316 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5317 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5318 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5319 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5320 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5321 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5322 action.
5323 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5324 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5325 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5326 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5327 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005329http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005333 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5334 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5335 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5336 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5337 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5338 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5339
5340http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5343 about <var-name>.
5344
5345 Example:
5346 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5347
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005348
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005349http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5350 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5351
5352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354
5355 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005356 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5357 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5358 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005359
5360 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5361
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005362 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5363 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5364 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5365 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5366 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5367 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5368 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5369 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5370 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5371 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005372
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005373 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5374 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5375 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5376 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5377 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5378 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5379 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5380 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005381
5382 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5383 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5384 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5385 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5386 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5387 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5388 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5389 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005390 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005391 downsides of rare connection failures.
5392
5393 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5394 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5395 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5396 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5397 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5398 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005400 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5401 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5402 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5403 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5404 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5405
5406 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5408 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5409 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005410
5411 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005413
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005414 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5415 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005416
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005417 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
5419 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5420 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5421 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5422
5423 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5424
5425
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005426http-send-name-header [<header>]
5427 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005430 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005431 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5432
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005433 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5434 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5435 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5436 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5437 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5438 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5439 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5440 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5441 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5442 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5443 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5444 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5445 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5446 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5447 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5448 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005449
5450 See also : "server"
5451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005452id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005453 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 no | yes | yes | yes
5456 Arguments : none
5457
5458 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5459 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5460 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005461
5462
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005463ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5464 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005466 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005467
5468 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5469 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5470 and running).
5471
5472 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5473 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5474 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005475 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005476 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5477
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5479 "unless" condition is met.
5480
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005481 Example:
5482 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5483 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5484 ignore-persist if url_static
5485
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005486 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5487
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005488load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5489 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5491 yes | no | yes | yes
5492
5493 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5494 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5495 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005497 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5498 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5499 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5500 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005502 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005504 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005505
5506 Arguments:
5507 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5508 named "server-state-file".
5509
5510 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5511 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5512 name is used as a file name.
5513
5514 none don't load any stat for this backend
5515
5516 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005517 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5518 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5519 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005520 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005521 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005522
5523 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5524 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005526 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005528 global
5529 stats socket /tmp/socket
5530 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005532 defaults
5533 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005535 backend bk
5536 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5537 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005538
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005539
5540 Then one can run :
5541
5542 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5543
5544 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5545
5546 1
5547 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5548 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5549 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005551 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005552
5553 global
5554 stats socket /tmp/socket
5555 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5556
5557 defaults
5558 load-server-state-from-file local
5559
5560 backend bk
5561 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5562 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005564
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005565 Then one can run :
5566
5567 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5568
5569 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5570
5571 1
5572 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5573 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5574 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5575
5576 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5577 "show servers state"
5578
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005580log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005581log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5582 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005583no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005587
5588 Prefix :
5589 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5590 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5591 prefix does not allow arguments.
5592
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593 Arguments :
5594 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5595 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5596 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5597 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5598 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5599 parameter.
5600
5601 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5602 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5603
5604 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5605 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5606 standard syslog port).
5607
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005608 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5609 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5610 standard syslog port).
5611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005612 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5613 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5614 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005615 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005616
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005617 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5618 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5619 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5620 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5621 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5622 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5623 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5624 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5625 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5626 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5627 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5628 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5629 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5630 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5631 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5632 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005633 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5634 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005635
5636 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5637 and "fd@2", see above.
5638
5639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5640 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005641
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005642 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5643 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5644 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5645 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5646 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5647 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5648 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5649 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5650 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5651 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005652 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005653
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005654 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5655 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5656 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5657 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5658 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5659
5660 <sample_size>
5661 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5662 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5663 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5664 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5665 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5666
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005667 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5668 one of the following :
5669
5670 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5671 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5672
5673 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5674 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5675
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005676 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5677 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5678 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5679 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5680 systemd logger consumes.
5681
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005682 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5683 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5684 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5685 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5688
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005689 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5690 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5691 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5692
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005693 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5694 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5695 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5696 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697
5698 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5699 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5700 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005701 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5702 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5703 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5704 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5705 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
5707 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5708
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005709 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5710 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5711 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005712
5713 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5714 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5715 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5716 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5717
5718 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5719 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
5721 Example :
5722 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005723 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5724 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5725 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005726 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5727 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005731log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005732 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005735
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005736 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5737 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5738 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5739 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5740 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005741
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005742 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5743 "option httplog" directives.
5744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005745log-format-sd <string>
5746 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | no
5749
5750 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5751 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5752 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5753 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5754 which covers the log format string in depth.
5755
5756 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5757 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5758
5759 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5760 log format to "rfc5424".
5761
5762 Example :
5763 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5764
5765
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005766log-tag <string>
5767 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
5770
5771 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5772 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5773 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5774 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5775 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5776 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5777 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5778 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5779 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005780
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005781max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5782 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 yes | no | yes | yes
5785
5786 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5787 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5788 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5789 servers.
5790
5791 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5792 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5793 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5794 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5795 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005797 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5798 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5799 picking a different server.
5800
5801 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5802 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5803 even if they have to be queued.
5804
5805 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5806 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5807
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005808max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5809 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5810 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5811 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005813maxconn <conns>
5814 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5816 yes | yes | yes | no
5817 Arguments :
5818 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5819 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5820 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5821 closes.
5822
5823 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5824 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5825 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5826 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005827 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5828 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5829 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5830 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
5832 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5833 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5834 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5835
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005836 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5837 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005839 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5840
5841
5842mode { tcp|http|health }
5843 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | yes | yes | yes
5846 Arguments :
5847 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5848 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5849 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5850 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5851
5852 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5853 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5854 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5855 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5856 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5857
5858 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005859 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5860 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5861 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5862 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5863 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5864 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5865 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005867 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5868 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5869 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005871 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872 defaults http_instances
5873 mode http
5874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005875 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005878monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005879 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 Arguments :
5883 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5884 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005885 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005886 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5887 backend and its backup.
5888
5889 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5890 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5891 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5892 servers in a list of backends.
5893
5894 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5895 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5896 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5897 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5898 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5899 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5900 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005901 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5902 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005903
5904 Example:
5905 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005906 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005907 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5908 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5909 monitor-uri /site_alive
5910 monitor fail if site_dead
5911
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005912 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
5914
5915monitor-net <source>
5916 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | no
5919 Arguments :
5920 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5921 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5922 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5923 followed by a mask.
5924
5925 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5926 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005927 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005928 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5929
5930 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5931 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5932 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5933 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005934 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5935 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5936 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005937
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005938 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5939 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5940 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5941 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5942 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5943 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005944
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005945 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5946 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005947
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005948 Example :
5949 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5950 frontend www
5951 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5952
5953 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5954
5955
5956monitor-uri <uri>
5957 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | yes | yes | no
5960 Arguments :
5961 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5962 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5963
5964 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5965 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5966 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5967 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5968 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5969 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5970 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5971 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5972
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005973 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5974 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5975 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5976 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5977 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5978 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5979 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5980 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005981
5982 Example :
5983 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5984 frontend www
5985 mode http
5986 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5987
5988 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005991option abortonclose
5992no option abortonclose
5993 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5995 yes | no | yes | yes
5996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5999 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6000 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6001 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006002 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6004 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6005 encountered while delivering the response.
6006
6007 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6008 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6009 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6010 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6011 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6012 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006015 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6017 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6018 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006020 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6021 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006022 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6023 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6024 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6025 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6026 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6027 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006028 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
6030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6032
6033 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6034
6035
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006036option accept-invalid-http-request
6037no option accept-invalid-http-request
6038 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6040 yes | yes | yes | no
6041 Arguments : none
6042
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006043 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006044 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006045 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006046 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6047 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6048 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6049 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6050 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006051 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6052 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6053 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6054 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006055 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006056 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006057 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6058 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6059 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006060
6061 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6062 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6063 been confirmed.
6064
6065 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6066 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006067 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6068 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006069 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6070
6071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6073
6074 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6075 stats socket.
6076
6077
6078option accept-invalid-http-response
6079no option accept-invalid-http-response
6080 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments : none
6084
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006085 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006086 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006088 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6089 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6090 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6091 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6092 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006093 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6094 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6095 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006096
6097 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6098 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6099 been confirmed.
6100
6101 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6102 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6103 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6104 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6105
6106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6108
6109 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6110 stats socket.
6111
6112
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006113option allbackups
6114no option allbackups
6115 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | no | yes | yes
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6121 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6122 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6123 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6124 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6125 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6126 order between the backup servers anymore.
6127
6128 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6129 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6130
6131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6133
6134
6135option checkcache
6136no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006137 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | no | yes | yes
6140 Arguments : none
6141
6142 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6143 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006144 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006145 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6146 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006147 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006148
6149 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006150 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006151 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6153 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006154 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006155 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006156 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6157 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006158 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006159 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6160 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006161 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006162 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6163 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6170 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6171
6172 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006173 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006174 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006175 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006176 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6177
6178 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6179 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006180 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006181 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006182
6183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6185
6186
6187option clitcpka
6188no option clitcpka
6189 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6191 yes | yes | yes | no
6192 Arguments : none
6193
6194 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6195 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006196 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006197 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6198
6199 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6200 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6201 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6202 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6203
6204 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6205 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6206 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6207 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6208 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6209
6210 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6211
6212 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6213 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6214 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
6219 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6220
6221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006222option contstats
6223 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6225 yes | yes | yes | no
6226 Arguments : none
6227
6228 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6229 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6230 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6231 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006232 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6233 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6234 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6235 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6236 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006237
6238
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006239option dontlog-normal
6240no option dontlog-normal
6241 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6247 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6248 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6249 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6250 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6251 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6252 logged.
6253
6254 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6255 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6256 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006259 logging.
6260
6261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006262option dontlognull
6263no option dontlognull
6264 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | no
6267 Arguments : none
6268
6269 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6270 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6271 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6272 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6273 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6274 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006275 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6276 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6277 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006278
6279 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006280 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006281 would not be logged.
6282
6283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6285
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006286 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006289
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006290option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006291 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments :
6295 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6296 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006297 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006298 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006299
6300 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6301 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6302 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6303 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6304 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6305 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6306 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006307 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6308 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6309 possible that the client has already brought one.
6310
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006311 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006312 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006313 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006314 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006315 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006316 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006317
6318 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6319 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6320 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6321 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6322 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6323 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6324 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6325
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006326 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6327 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6328 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6329 are under the control of the end-user.
6330
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006331 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006332 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6333 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006334 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6335 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6336 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006337
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006338 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006339 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6340 frontend www
6341 mode http
6342 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6343
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006344 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6345 backend www
6346 mode http
6347 option forwardfor header X-Client
6348
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006349 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006350 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006351
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006352
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006353option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6354no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6355 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6357 yes | yes | yes | no
6358 Arguments : none
6359
6360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6367
6368 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6369 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6370 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6371 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6372 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6373 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6374 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6375 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6376 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6377 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6378
6379 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6380
6381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6383
6384 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6385 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6386
6387
6388option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6389no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6390 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 yes | no | yes | yes
6393 Arguments : none
6394
6395 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6396 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6397 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6398 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6399 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6400 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6401 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6402
6403 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6404 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6405 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6406 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6407 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6408 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6409 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6410 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6411 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6412 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6413
6414 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6415
6416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6418
6419 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6420 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6421
6422
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006423option http-buffer-request
6424no option http-buffer-request
6425 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6427 yes | yes | yes | yes
6428 Arguments : none
6429
6430 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6431 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6432 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6433 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6434 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6435 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6436 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6437 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006438 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006439 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6440 default.
6441
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006442 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006443
6444
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006445option http-ignore-probes
6446no option http-ignore-probes
6447 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | yes | yes | no
6450 Arguments : none
6451
6452 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6453 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6454 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6455 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6456 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6457 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6458 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6459 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6460 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006461 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6462 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006463 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6464
6465 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6466 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6467 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6468 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6469 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6470 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6471 are often the only way to detect them.
6472
6473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6475
6476 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6477
6478
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006479option http-keep-alive
6480no option http-keep-alive
6481 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | yes | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006486 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6487 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006488 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6489 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6490 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6491 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6492 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006493
6494 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6495 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006496 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6497 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6498 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6499 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6500 situations where this option may be useful :
6501
6502 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006503 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006504
6505 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6506 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6507
6508 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6509 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6510 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6511 request.
6512
6513 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6514 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006515 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6516 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6517 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006518
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006519 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6520 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6521 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6522 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6523 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6524 not set.
6525
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006526 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006527 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6528 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006531 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006532 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006533
6534
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006535option http-no-delay
6536no option http-no-delay
6537 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6539 yes | yes | yes | yes
6540 Arguments : none
6541
6542 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6543 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6544 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6545 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6546 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6547 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6548 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6549 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6550 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6551 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6552 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6553 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6554 affected.
6555
6556 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6557 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6558 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6559 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6560 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6561 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6562 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6563 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6564 latency environments.
6565
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006566 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6567
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006568
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006569option http-pretend-keepalive
6570no option http-pretend-keepalive
6571 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006573 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006574 Arguments : none
6575
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006576 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006577 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6578 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6579 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6580 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6581 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6582 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6583 consider the response complete.
6584
6585 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6586 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6587 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6588 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006589 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006590 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6591
6592 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6593 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6594 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6595 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6596 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6597 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6598 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6599
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006600 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6601 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6602 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6603 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6604 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6605 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006606
6607 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6608 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6609
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006610 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006611 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006612
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006613
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006614option http-server-close
6615no option http-server-close
6616 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6618 yes | yes | yes | yes
6619 Arguments : none
6620
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006621 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6622 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6623 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6624 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006625 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6626 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6627 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6628 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6629 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6630 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6631 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6632 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6633 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6634 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6635 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006636
6637 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6638 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6639 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6640 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006641 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6642 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006643
6644 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6645 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006646 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6647 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6648 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006649
6650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6652
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006653 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6654 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006655
6656
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006657option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6658no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6659 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006661 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006662 Arguments : none
6663
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006664 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6665 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6666 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6667
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006668 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6669 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6670 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6671 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006672 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006673
6674 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006675 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006676 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6677 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6678 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6679 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6680 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6681 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6682 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006683
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006684 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6685 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6686 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6687 backend.
6688
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6691
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006692 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6693 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006694
6695
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006696option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006697no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006698 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 yes | yes | yes | no
6701 Arguments : none
6702
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006703 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006704 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6705 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6706 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6707 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6708 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6709 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6710
6711 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6712 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006713 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6714 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6715 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006716
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006717 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6718 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6719 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6720 front of an existing proxy.
6721
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006722 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6723
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006724 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006725
6726
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006727option http-use-htx
6728no option http-use-htx
6729 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | yes | yes | yes
6732 Arguments : none
6733
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006734 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006735 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006736 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6737 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6738 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6739 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6740 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006741
6742 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6743 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6744 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6745 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006746 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6747 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6748 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6749 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006750
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006751 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6752 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6753 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6754 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6755 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006756
6757 See also : "mode http"
6758
6759
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006760option httpchk
6761option httpchk <uri>
6762option httpchk <method> <uri>
6763option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6764 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6766 yes | no | yes | yes
6767 Arguments :
6768 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6769 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6770 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6771 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6772 ones.
6773
6774 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6775 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6776 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6777
6778 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6779 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6780 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006781 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006782
6783 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6784 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6785 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6786 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6787 the lack of any response.
6788
6789 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6790
6791 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6792 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6793 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6794
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006795 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6796 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6797 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6798 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6799
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006800 Examples :
6801 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6802 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6803 backend https_relay
6804 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006805 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6806 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006807 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6808
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006809 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6810 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6811 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006812
6813
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006814option httpclose
6815no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006816 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | yes | yes | yes
6819 Arguments : none
6820
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006821 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6822 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6823 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6824 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006825 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006826
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006827 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6828 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006829 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006830 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6831 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006832
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006833 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6834 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6835 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006836
6837 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6838 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006839 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006840 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6841 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6842 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006843
6844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6846
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006847 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006848
6849
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006850option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006853 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006854 Arguments :
6855 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6856 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6857 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006858 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006859 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006860
6861 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6862 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6863 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6864 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6865 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6866 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6867 ports.
6868
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006869 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6870 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006871
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006872 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006874 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006875
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006876
6877option http_proxy
6878no option http_proxy
6879 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | yes | yes | yes
6882 Arguments : none
6883
6884 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6885 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6886 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6887 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6888 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6889
6890 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6891 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006892 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6893 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006894
6895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6897
6898 Example :
6899 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6900 backend direct_forward
6901 option httpclose
6902 option http_proxy
6903
6904 See also : "option httpclose"
6905
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006906
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006907option independent-streams
6908no option independent-streams
6909 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6911 yes | yes | yes | yes
6912 Arguments : none
6913
6914 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6915 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6916 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6917 receive data or not.
6918
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006919 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006920 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6921 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6922 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6923 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6924 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6925 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6926 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6927 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6928 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6929 socket buffers.
6930
6931 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6932 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6933 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6934 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6935 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6936
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006937 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006938 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6939 deprecated.
6940
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006941 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006942
6943
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006944option ldap-check
6945 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6947 yes | no | yes | yes
6948 Arguments : none
6949
6950 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6951 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6952 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6953 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6954
6955 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6956 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6957
6958 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6959 configure it.
6960
6961 Example :
6962 option ldap-check
6963
6964 See also : "option httpchk"
6965
6966
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006967option external-check
6968 Use external processes for server health checks
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | no | yes | yes
6971
6972 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6973 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6974 command".
6975
6976 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6977
6978 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6979
6980
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006981option log-health-checks
6982no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006983 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | no | yes | yes
6986 Arguments : none
6987
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006988 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6989 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6990 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006991
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006992 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6993 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6994 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6995 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6996 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6997
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006998 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006999 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007000
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007001 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7002 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7003 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007004
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007005
7006option log-separate-errors
7007no option log-separate-errors
7008 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7010 yes | yes | yes | no
7011 Arguments : none
7012
7013 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7014 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7015 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7016 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7017 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7018 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7019 provides very important information.
7020
7021 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7022 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7023 error logs.
7024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007025 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007026 logging.
7027
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007028
7029option logasap
7030no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007031 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 yes | yes | yes | no
7034 Arguments : none
7035
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007036 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7037 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7038 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7039 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7040
7041 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7042 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7043 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7044 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7045 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7046 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7047 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7048 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7049 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7050 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7051 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007053 Examples :
7054 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7055 mode http
7056 option httplog
7057 option logasap
7058 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7059
7060 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7061 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7062 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7063 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007065 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007066 logging.
7067
7068
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007069option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007070 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7072 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007073 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007074 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7075 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007076 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007077
7078 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7079 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007080 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007081 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7082 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7083 in the MySQL table, like this :
7084
7085 USE mysql;
7086 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7087 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7088
7089 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007090 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007091 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7092 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7093 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7094 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7095 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7096 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7097 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7098
7099 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7100 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007101
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007102 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007103
7104 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7105 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7106 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7107 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007108 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7109 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007110
7111 See also: "option httpchk"
7112
7113
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007114option nolinger
7115no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007116 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7118 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007119 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007121 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007122 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7123 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7124 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7125 connections.
7126
7127 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7128 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7129 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7130 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7131 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7132 this too.
7133
7134 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7135 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7136 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7137
7138 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7139 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7140 for servers.
7141
7142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7144
7145
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007146option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7147 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 yes | yes | yes | yes
7150 Arguments :
7151 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7152 matching <network>
7153 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7154 header name.
7155
7156 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7157 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7158 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7159 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7160 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7161 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7162 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7163 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7164 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7165 possible that the client has already brought one.
7166
7167 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7168 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7169 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7170 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7171 header and requires different one.
7172
7173 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7174 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7175 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7176 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7177 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7178 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7179 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7180
7181 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7182 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7183 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7184 both are defined.
7185
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007186 Examples :
7187 # Original Destination address
7188 frontend www
7189 mode http
7190 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7191
7192 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7193 backend www
7194 mode http
7195 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007197 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007198
7199
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007200option persist
7201no option persist
7202 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007205 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007206
7207 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7208 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7209 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7210 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7211 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7212 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7213 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7214 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7215 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7216 redirected to another valid server.
7217
7218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007221 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007222
7223
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007224option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7225 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7227 yes | no | yes | yes
7228 Arguments :
7229 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7230 PostgreSQL server.
7231
7232 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7233 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7234 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7235 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7236
7237 See also: "option httpchk"
7238
7239
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007240option prefer-last-server
7241no option prefer-last-server
7242 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 yes | no | yes | yes
7245 Arguments : none
7246
7247 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7248 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7249 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7250 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7251 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7252 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7253 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7254 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7255 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007256 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7257 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007258 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7259 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7260 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007261 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7262 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7263 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007264
7265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7267
7268 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7269
7270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007271option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007272option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007273no option redispatch
7274 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7276 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007277 Arguments :
7278 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7279 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7280 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007281 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007282 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007283 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007284 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7285 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7286 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007288
7289 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7290 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7291 be able to access the service anymore.
7292
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007293 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7294 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007295
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007296 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007297 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7298 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007300 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7301 "redisp" keywords.
7302
7303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7305
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007306 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007307
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007308
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007309option redis-check
7310 Use redis health checks for server testing
7311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7312 yes | no | yes | yes
7313 Arguments : none
7314
7315 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7316 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7317 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7318 find the "+PONG" response message.
7319
7320 Example :
7321 option redis-check
7322
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007323 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007324
7325
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007326option smtpchk
7327option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7328 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007331 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007332 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007333 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007334 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7335
7336 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7337 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7338 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7339
7340 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7341 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7342 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7343 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7344 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7345 dead server.
7346
7347 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7348 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007349 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007350 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7351
7352 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7353 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7354 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7355 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007356 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007357
7358 Example :
7359 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7360
7361 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007364option socket-stats
7365no option socket-stats
7366
7367 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 yes | yes | yes | no
7370
7371 Arguments : none
7372
7373
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007374option splice-auto
7375no option splice-auto
7376 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 yes | yes | yes | yes
7379 Arguments : none
7380
7381 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7382 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007383 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007384 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007385 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007386 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7387 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7388 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7389 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7390
7391 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7392 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7393 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7394 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7395 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7396 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7397 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7398 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7399 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7400 keyword.
7401
7402 Example :
7403 option splice-auto
7404
7405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7407
7408 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7409 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7410
7411
7412option splice-request
7413no option splice-request
7414 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 yes | yes | yes | yes
7417 Arguments : none
7418
7419 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007420 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007421 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7422 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7423 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7424 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7425
7426 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7427
7428 Example :
7429 option splice-request
7430
7431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7433
7434 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7435 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7436
7437
7438option splice-response
7439no option splice-response
7440 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 yes | yes | yes | yes
7443 Arguments : none
7444
7445 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007446 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007447 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7448 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7449 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7450 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7451
7452 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7453
7454 Example :
7455 option splice-response
7456
7457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7459
7460 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7461 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7462
7463
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007464option spop-check
7465 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 no | no | no | yes
7468 Arguments : none
7469
7470 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7471 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7472 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7473 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7474
7475 Example :
7476 option spop-check
7477
7478 See also : "option httpchk"
7479
7480
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007481option srvtcpka
7482no option srvtcpka
7483 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 yes | no | yes | yes
7486 Arguments : none
7487
7488 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7489 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007490 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007491 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7492
7493 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7494 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7495 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7496 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7497
7498 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7499 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7500 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7501 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7502 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7503
7504 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7505
7506 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7507 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7508 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7509
7510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7512
7513 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7514
7515
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007516option ssl-hello-chk
7517 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7519 yes | no | yes | yes
7520 Arguments : none
7521
7522 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7523 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7524 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7525 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7526 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7527 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7528 hello message.
7529
7530 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7531 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7532 messages, which is appreciable.
7533
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007534 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7535 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7536 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007537
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007538 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7539
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007540
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007541option tcp-check
7542 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 yes | no | yes | yes
7545
7546 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7547 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7548
7549 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7550 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7551 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7552
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007553 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007554 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7555 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7556 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7557 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7558 only.
7559
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007560 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007561 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7562 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7563 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7564 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7565
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007566 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007567 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7568 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007569 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007570 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7571 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7572 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7573 the respective protocols.
7574 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007575 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007576
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007577 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7578 script.
7579
7580 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7581 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7582 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7583 The "comment" is of course optional.
7584
7585
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007586 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007587 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007588 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007589 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007590
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007591 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007592 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007593 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007594
7595 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7596 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007597 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007598 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007599 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007600 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007601 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007602 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007603 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7604 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007605 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007606 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7607 tcp-check expect string +OK
7608
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007609 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007610 (send many headers before analyzing)
7611 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007612 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007613 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7614 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7615 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7616 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007617 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007618
7619
7620 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7621
7622
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007623option tcp-smart-accept
7624no option tcp-smart-accept
7625 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7627 yes | yes | yes | no
7628 Arguments : none
7629
7630 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7631 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7632 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7633 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7634 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7635 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7636
7637 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7638 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7639 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7640 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7641
7642 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7643 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7644 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007645 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007646
7647 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7648 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7649 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7650
7651 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7652 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7653 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7654
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007655 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7656
7657
7658option tcp-smart-connect
7659no option tcp-smart-connect
7660 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7662 yes | no | yes | yes
7663 Arguments : none
7664
7665 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7666 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7667 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7668 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7669 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7670
7671 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7672 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7673 complex.
7674
7675 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7676 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7677 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7678
7679 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7680 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7681
7682 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7683
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007684
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007685option tcpka
7686 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 yes | yes | yes | yes
7689 Arguments : none
7690
7691 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7692 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007693 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007694 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7695
7696 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7697 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7698 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7699 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7700
7701 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7702 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7703 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7704 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7705 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7706
7707 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7708
7709 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7710 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7711 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7712 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7713 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7714 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7715 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7716 backends.
7717
7718 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7719
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007720
7721option tcplog
7722 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007724 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007725 Arguments : none
7726
7727 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7728 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7729 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7730 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7731 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7732 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7733 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7734 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7735
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007736 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007738 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007739
7740
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007741option transparent
7742no option transparent
7743 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007746 Arguments : none
7747
7748 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7749 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7750 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7751 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7752 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7753 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7754 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7755 appropriate server.
7756
7757 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7758 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7759
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007760 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007761 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007762
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007763
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007764external-check command <command>
7765 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7767 yes | no | yes | yes
7768
7769 Arguments :
7770 <command> is the external command to run
7771
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007772 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7773
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007774 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007775
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007776 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7777 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7778 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7779 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7780 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7781 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007782
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007783 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7784
7785 Environment variables :
7786 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7787 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7788
7789 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7790
7791 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7792
7793 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7794 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7795 for a UNIX socket).
7796
7797 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7798
7799 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7800
7801 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7802
7803 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7804
7805 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7806
7807 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7808 socket).
7809
7810 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7811 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7812
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007813 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7814
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007815 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7816 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7817 failed.
7818
7819 Example :
7820 external-check command /bin/true
7821
7822 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7823
7824
7825external-check path <path>
7826 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | no | yes | yes
7829
7830 Arguments :
7831 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7832
7833 The default path is "".
7834
7835 Example :
7836 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7837
7838 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7839 "external-check command"
7840
7841
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007842persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007843persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007844 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | no | yes | yes
7847 Arguments :
7848 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007849 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7850 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007851
7852 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7853 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007854 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007855 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7856 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7857 forwarded to this server.
7858
7859 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7860 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7861 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007862 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007863 a single "listen" section.
7864
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007865 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7866 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7867 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7868
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007869 Example :
7870 listen tse-farm
7871 bind :3389
7872 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7873 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7874 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7875 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7876 persist rdp-cookie
7877 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007878 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007879 balance rdp-cookie
7880 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7881 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7882
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007883 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7884 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007885
7886
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007887rate-limit sessions <rate>
7888 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 yes | yes | yes | no
7891 Arguments :
7892 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7893 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7894
7895 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7896 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7897 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7898 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7899 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7900 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7901
7902 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7903 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7904 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7905 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7906
7907 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7908 listen smtp
7909 mode tcp
7910 bind :25
7911 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007912 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007913
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007914 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7915 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7916 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007917
7918 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7919
7920
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007921redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7922redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7923redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007924 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 no | yes | yes | yes
7927
7928 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007929 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007930
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007931 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007932 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007933 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7934 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7935 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007936
7937 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7938 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7939 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7940 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7941 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007942 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7943 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7944 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7945 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007946
7947 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7948 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7949 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7950 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7951 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7952 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007953 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007954 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007955 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7956 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7957 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007958
7959 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007960 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7961 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7962 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007963 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007964 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7965 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7966 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7967 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007968
7969 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007970 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007971
7972 - "drop-query"
7973 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7974 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7975 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7976 with a location-type redirect.
7977
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007978 - "append-slash"
7979 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7980 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7981 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7982 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7983
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007984 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7985 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7986 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7987 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7988 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7989 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7990 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7991
7992 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7993 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7994 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7995 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7996 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7997 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7998 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007999
8000 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8001 acl clear dst_port 80
8002 acl secure dst_port 8080
8003 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008004 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008005 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008006 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8007
8008 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008009 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8010 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8011 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008012 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008013
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008014 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8015 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8016 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8017
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008018 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008019 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008020
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008021 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008022 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8023 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8024 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008026 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008027
8028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008029redisp (deprecated)
8030redispatch (deprecated)
8031 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008034 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008035
8036 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8037 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8038 be able to access the service anymore.
8039
8040 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8041 redistribute them to a working server.
8042
8043 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8044 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8045 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008047 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8048 "option redispatch" instead.
8049
8050 See also : "option redispatch"
8051
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008052
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008053reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008054 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8056 no | yes | yes | yes
8057 Arguments :
8058 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8059 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008060 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008061
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008062 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8063 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8064
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008065 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8066 the last header of an HTTP request.
8067
8068 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8069 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8070 responses.
8071
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008072 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8073 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8074 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8075
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008076 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8077 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008078
8079
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008080reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8081reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 no | yes | yes | yes
8085 Arguments :
8086 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8087 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8088 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8089 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8090 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8091 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8092 ignores case.
8093
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008094 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8095 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8096
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008097 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8098 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8099 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8100 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008101 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008102
8103 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8104 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8105
8106 Example :
8107 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8108 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8109 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8110
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008111 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8112 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008113
8114
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008115reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8116reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008117 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8119 no | yes | yes | yes
8120 Arguments :
8121 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8122 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8123 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8124 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8125 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8126 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8127
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008128 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8129 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8130
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008131 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8132 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8133 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8134 next servers.
8135
8136 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8137 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8138 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8139
8140 Example :
8141 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8142 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8143 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8144
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008145 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8146 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008147
8148
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008149reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8150reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008151 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8153 no | yes | yes | yes
8154 Arguments :
8155 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8156 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8157 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8158 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8159 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8160 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8161 case.
8162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008163 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8164 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8165
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008166 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8167 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8168 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8169 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008170 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008171
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008172 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008173 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008174 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008175
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008176 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8177 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8178
8179 Example :
8180 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8181 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8182 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8183
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008184 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8185 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008186
8187
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008188reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8189reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008190 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | yes | yes | yes
8193 Arguments :
8194 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8195 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8196 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8197 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8198 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8199 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8200 case.
8201
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008202 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8203 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8204
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008205 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8206 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8207 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8208 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8209
8210 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8211 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8212
8213 Example :
8214 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8215 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8216 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8217 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8218
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008219 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8220 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008221
8222
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008223reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8224reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008225 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8227 no | yes | yes | yes
8228 Arguments :
8229 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8230 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8231 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8232 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8233 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8234 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8235
8236 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8237 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8238 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8239 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008240 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008245 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8246 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8247 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8248
8249 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8250 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8251 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8252 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8253 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8254
8255 Example :
8256 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008257 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008258 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8259 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8260
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008261 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8262 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008263
8264
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008265reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8266reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008267 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 no | yes | yes | yes
8270 Arguments :
8271 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8272 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8273 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8274 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8275 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8276 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8277 ignores case.
8278
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008279 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8280 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8281
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008282 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8283 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008284 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8285 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8286 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008287 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8288 not set.
8289
8290 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8291 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8292 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8293 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8294 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008296 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008297 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008298 # block all others.
8299 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8300 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8301
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008302 # block bad guys
8303 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8304 reqitarpit . if badguys
8305
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008306 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8307 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008308
8309
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008310retries <value>
8311 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8313 yes | no | yes | yes
8314 Arguments :
8315 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8316 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8317 default value is 3.
8318
8319 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8320 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8321 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8322
8323 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008324 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8325 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008326
8327 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8328 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8329
8330 See also : "option redispatch"
8331
8332
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008333retry-on [list of keywords]
8334 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 yes | no | yes | yes
8337 Arguments :
8338 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8339 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8340 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8341 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8342
8343 none never retry
8344
8345 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8346 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8347
8348 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8349 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8350 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8351 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8352 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8353 processing the request.
8354
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008355 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8356 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8357 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8358 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8359 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8360 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8361 overflow attack for example).
8362
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008363 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8364 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8365 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8366 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8367 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8368 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8369 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8370 amplify denial of service attacks.
8371
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008372 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8373 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8374 considered to be safe to retry.
8375
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008376 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8377 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8378 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8379 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8380
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008381 all-retryable-errors
8382 retry request for any error that are considered
8383 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8384 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8385 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8386
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008387 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8388 not cumulative.
8389
8390 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8391 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8392 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8393 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8394
8395 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8396 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8397 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8398 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8399 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8400 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8401 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8402 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8403 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8404 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8405 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8406 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8407
8408 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8409 should not use this directive.
8410
8411 The default is "conn-failure".
8412
8413 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8414
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008415rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008416 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 no | yes | yes | yes
8419 Arguments :
8420 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8421 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008422 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008423
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008424 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8425 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8426
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008427 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8428 the last header of an HTTP response.
8429
8430 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8431 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8432 responses.
8433
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008434 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8435 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008436
8437
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008438rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8439rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008440 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 no | yes | yes | yes
8443 Arguments :
8444 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8445 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8446 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8447 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8448 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8449 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8450 ignores case.
8451
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008452 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8453 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8454
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008455 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8456 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008457 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008458 client.
8459
8460 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8461 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8462 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8463
8464 Example :
8465 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008466 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008467
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008468 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8469 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008470
8471
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008472rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8473rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008474 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 no | yes | yes | yes
8477 Arguments :
8478 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8479 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8480 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8481 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8482 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8483 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8484 ignores case.
8485
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008486 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8487 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8488
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008489 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8490 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8491 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8492 case-sensitive.
8493
8494 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008495 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8496 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8497 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008498
8499 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8500 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8501
8502 Example :
8503 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8504 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8505
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008506 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8507 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008508
8509
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008510rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8511rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008512 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 no | yes | yes | yes
8515 Arguments :
8516 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8517 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8518 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8519 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8520 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8521 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8522 ignores case.
8523
8524 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8525 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8526 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8527 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008528 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008529
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008530 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8531 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8532
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008533 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8534 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8535 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8536
8537 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8538 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8539 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8540 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8541 are not case-sensitive.
8542
8543 Example :
8544 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8545 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8546
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008547 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8548 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008549
8550
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008551server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008552 Declare a server in a backend
8553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8554 no | no | yes | yes
8555 Arguments :
8556 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008558 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008559
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008560 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8561 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8562 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8563 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008564 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8565 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8566 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8567 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8568 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008569 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8570 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8571 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8572 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8573 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8574 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8575 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008576 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008577 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8578 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8579 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8580 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8581 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8582 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008583 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8584 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008585 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8586 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008588 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008589 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8590 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8591 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8592 adding this value to the client's port.
8593
8594 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8595 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008596 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008597
8598 Examples :
8599 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8600 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008601 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008602 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8603 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8604 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008605
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008606 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8607 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8608 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8609 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8610 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8611
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008612 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8613 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008614
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008615server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008616 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008617 this backend.
8618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8619 no | no | yes | yes
8620
8621 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
8622 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
8623 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
8624 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
8625 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008626
8627 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8628 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8629
8630 global
8631 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8632
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008633 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008634 load-server-state-from-file
8635
Christopher Fauletea1300f2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01008636 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008637 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008639server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8640 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8641 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8643 no | no | yes | yes
8644
8645 Arguments:
8646 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8647
8648 <num | range>
8649 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8650 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8651 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8652 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8653
8654 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8655
8656 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8657
8658 <params*>
8659 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8660 keyword.
8661
8662 Examples:
8663 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8664 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8665 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8666
8667 # or
8668 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8669
8670 # would be equivalent to:
8671 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8672 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8673 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8674
8675
8676
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008678source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008679source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008680 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8682 yes | no | yes | yes
8683 Arguments :
8684 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8685 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008687 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008688 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8689 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8690 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8691 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8692 supported prefixes are :
8693 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8694 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8695 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008696 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008697 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8698 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008699
8700 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8701 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008702 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8703 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8704 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008705
8706 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8707 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8708 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8709 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8710 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8711 <addr>.
8712
8713 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8714 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8715 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8716 port.
8717
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008718 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8719 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8720 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8721 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008722 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008723 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8724 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8725 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8726 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8727 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8728 HTTP header.
8729
8730 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8731 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008732 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008733 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8734 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8735 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8736 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8737 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8738 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8739 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8740
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008741 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8742 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8743 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8744 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8745 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8746 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8747
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008748 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8749 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8750 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8751 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8752
8753 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8754 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8755 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8756 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8757 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8758 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8759
8760 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8761 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8762 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8763 there are two methods :
8764
8765 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8766 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8767 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8768 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8769 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8770 of the client ranges may be used.
8771
8772 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8773 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8774 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8775 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8776 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8777 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8778 same session.
8779
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008780 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8781 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8782 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008784
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008785 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8786
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008787 Examples :
8788 backend private
8789 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8790 source 192.168.1.200
8791
8792 backend transparent_ssl1
8793 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8794 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8795
8796 backend transparent_ssl2
8797 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8798 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8799 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8800
8801 backend transparent_ssl3
8802 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8803 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8804 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8805
8806 backend transparent_smtp
8807 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8808 # with Tproxy version 4.
8809 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8810
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008811 backend transparent_http
8812 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8813 # proxy.
8814 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008816 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008817 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008819
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008820srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8821 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | no | yes | yes
8824 Arguments :
8825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8827 as explained at the top of this document.
8828
8829 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8830 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8831 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8832 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8833 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8834 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8835 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8836
8837 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8838 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8839 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8840 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8841 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008842 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008843 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008844 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008845
8846 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8847 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8848 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8849 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8850 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8851 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8852
8853 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8854 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8855
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008856 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8857 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008858
8859
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008860stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8861 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008863 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008864
8865 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8866 matched.
8867
8868 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8869 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8870
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008871 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8872 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008873 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008874
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008875 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8876 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8877 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8878 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008879
8880 Example :
8881 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8882 backend stats_localhost
8883 stats enable
8884 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8885
8886 Example :
8887 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8888 backend stats_auth
8889 stats enable
8890 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8891 stats admin if TRUE
8892
8893 Example :
8894 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8895 userlist stats-auth
8896 group admin users admin
8897 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8898 group readonly users haproxy
8899 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8900
8901 backend stats_auth
8902 stats enable
8903 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8904 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8905 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8906 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8907
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008908 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8909 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8910 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008911
8912
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008913stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8914 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008917 Arguments :
8918 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8919
8920 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8921
8922 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8923 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8924 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8925 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8926 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8927 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8928
8929 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8930 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8931 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008932 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008933
8934 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8935 report using "stats scope".
8936
8937 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8938 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8939 unobvious parameters.
8940
8941 Example :
8942 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8943 backend public_www
8944 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8945 stats enable
8946 stats hide-version
8947 stats scope .
8948 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008949 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008950 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8951 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8952
8953 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8954 backend private_monitoring
8955 stats enable
8956 stats uri /admin?stats
8957 stats refresh 5s
8958
8959 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8960
8961
8962stats enable
8963 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008966 Arguments : none
8967
8968 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8969 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8970 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8971 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8972 - stats auth : no authentication
8973 - stats scope : no restriction
8974
8975 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8976 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8977 unobvious parameters.
8978
8979 Example :
8980 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8981 backend public_www
8982 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8983 stats enable
8984 stats hide-version
8985 stats scope .
8986 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008987 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008988 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8989 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8990
8991 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8992 backend private_monitoring
8993 stats enable
8994 stats uri /admin?stats
8995 stats refresh 5s
8996
8997 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8998
8999
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009000stats hide-version
9001 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009004 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009006 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9007 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9008 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9009 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9010 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9011 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9015 unobvious parameters.
9016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009017 Example :
9018 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9019 backend public_www
9020 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009021 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009022 stats hide-version
9023 stats scope .
9024 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009025 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009026 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9027 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009028
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009029 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9030 backend private_monitoring
9031 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032 stats uri /admin?stats
9033 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009035 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009036
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009037
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009038stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9039 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9040 Access control for statistics
9041
9042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9043 no | no | yes | yes
9044
9045 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9046 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9047 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9048 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9049 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9050 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9051
9052 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9053 instance.
9054
9055 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9056 about ACL usage.
9057
9058
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009059stats realm <realm>
9060 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009062 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009063 Arguments :
9064 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9065 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9066 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9067
9068 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9069 using a backslash ('\').
9070
9071 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9072 only related to authentication.
9073
9074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9076 unobvious parameters.
9077
9078 Example :
9079 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9080 backend public_www
9081 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9082 stats enable
9083 stats hide-version
9084 stats scope .
9085 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009086 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009087 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9088 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9089
9090 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9091 backend private_monitoring
9092 stats enable
9093 stats uri /admin?stats
9094 stats refresh 5s
9095
9096 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9097
9098
9099stats refresh <delay>
9100 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009102 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009103 Arguments :
9104 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9105 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9106 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9107 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9108 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9109 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9110
9111 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9112 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9113 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9114 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9115
9116 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9117 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9118 unobvious parameters.
9119
9120 Example :
9121 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9122 backend public_www
9123 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9124 stats enable
9125 stats hide-version
9126 stats scope .
9127 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009129 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9130 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9131
9132 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9133 backend private_monitoring
9134 stats enable
9135 stats uri /admin?stats
9136 stats refresh 5s
9137
9138 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9139
9140
9141stats scope { <name> | "." }
9142 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009144 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009145 Arguments :
9146 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9147 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9148 section in which the statement appears.
9149
9150 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9151 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9152 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9153 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9154 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9155 exists.
9156
9157 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9158 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9159 unobvious parameters.
9160
9161 Example :
9162 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9163 backend public_www
9164 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9165 stats enable
9166 stats hide-version
9167 stats scope .
9168 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009169 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009170 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9171 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9172
9173 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9174 backend private_monitoring
9175 stats enable
9176 stats uri /admin?stats
9177 stats refresh 5s
9178
9179 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9180
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009181
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009182stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009186
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009187 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009188 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9189
9190 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9191 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9192
9193 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9194 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009195 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009196
9197 Example :
9198 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9199 backend private_monitoring
9200 stats enable
9201 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9202 stats uri /admin?stats
9203 stats refresh 5s
9204
9205 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9206 global section.
9207
9208
9209stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009210 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 yes | yes | yes | yes
9213 Arguments : none
9214
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009215 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009216 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9217 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9218 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9219 - IP (socket, server)
9220 - cookie (backend, server)
9221
9222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009224 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009225
9226 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9227
9228
9229stats show-node [ <name> ]
9230 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009232 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009233 Arguments:
9234 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9235 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9236
9237 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9238 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009239 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009240
9241 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9242 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9243 unobvious parameters.
9244
9245 Example:
9246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9247 backend private_monitoring
9248 stats enable
9249 stats show-node Europe-1
9250 stats uri /admin?stats
9251 stats refresh 5s
9252
9253 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9254 section.
9255
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009256
9257stats uri <prefix>
9258 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009261 Arguments :
9262 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9263 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9264 query string.
9265
9266 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9267 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9268 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9269 possible to reach it in the application.
9270
9271 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009272 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009273 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9274 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9275 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9276 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9277
9278 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9279 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9280 an address or a port to statistics only.
9281
9282 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9283 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9284 unobvious parameters.
9285
9286 Example :
9287 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9288 backend public_www
9289 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9290 stats enable
9291 stats hide-version
9292 stats scope .
9293 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009294 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009295 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9296 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9297
9298 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9299 backend private_monitoring
9300 stats enable
9301 stats uri /admin?stats
9302 stats refresh 5s
9303
9304 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9305
9306
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009307stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9308 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009310 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009311
9312 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009313 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009314 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009315 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009316 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9317
9318 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9319 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9320 the "stick-table" statement.
9321
9322 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9323 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9324 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9325 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9326 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9327
9328 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9329 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9330 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9331 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9332 transformation rules.
9333
9334 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9335 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9336 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9337 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9338 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9339 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9340 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9341
9342 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9343 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9344 ACL based conditions.
9345
9346 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9347 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9348 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9349 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9350
9351 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9352 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9353 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9354 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9355
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009356 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9357 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009358 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009359
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009360 Example :
9361 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9362 # last 30 minutes
9363 backend pop
9364 mode tcp
9365 balance roundrobin
9366 stick store-request src
9367 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9368 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9369 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9370
9371 backend smtp
9372 mode tcp
9373 balance roundrobin
9374 stick match src table pop
9375 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9376 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9377
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009378 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009379 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009380
9381
9382stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9383 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9385 no | no | yes | yes
9386
9387 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9388 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9389 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9390 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9391
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009392 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9393 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009394 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009395
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009396 Examples :
9397 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009398 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009399
9400 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9401 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9402 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9403
9404
9405 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9406 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9407 backend http
9408 mode http
9409 balance roundrobin
9410 stick on src table https
9411 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9412 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9413 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9414
9415 backend https
9416 mode tcp
9417 balance roundrobin
9418 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9419 stick on src
9420 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9421 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9422
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009423 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009424
9425
9426stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9427 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 no | no | yes | yes
9430
9431 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009432 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009433 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009434 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009435 server is selected.
9436
9437 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9438 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9439 the "stick-table" statement.
9440
9441 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9442 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9443 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9444 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9445 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9446 address.
9447
9448 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9449 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9450 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9451 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9452 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9453 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9454 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9455 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9456 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9457 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9458
9459 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9460 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9461 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9462 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9463 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9464 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9465 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9466
9467 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9468 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9469 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9470 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9471
9472 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9473 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9474 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9475 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9476 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9477 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009478 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9479 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9480 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9481 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9482 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9483 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009484
9485 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9486 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9487 the request.
9488
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009489 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9490 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009491 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009492
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009493 Example :
9494 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9495 # last 30 minutes
9496 backend pop
9497 mode tcp
9498 balance roundrobin
9499 stick store-request src
9500 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9501 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9502 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9503
9504 backend smtp
9505 mode tcp
9506 balance roundrobin
9507 stick match src table pop
9508 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9509 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9510
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009511 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009512 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009513
9514
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009515stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009516 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9517 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009518 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009520 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009521
9522 Arguments :
9523 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9524 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9525 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9526 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9527
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009528 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9529 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9530 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9531 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9532
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009533 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9534 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9535 instance.
9536
9537 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9538 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9539 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9540 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9541 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9542 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009543 to 32 characters.
9544
9545 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9546 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9547 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009548 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009549 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9550 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009551
9552 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009553 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9554 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009555 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9556 increase.
9557
9558 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009559 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9560 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9561 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009562
9563 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9564 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9565 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9566 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009568 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9569 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9570 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9571 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9572 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9573 parameter (see below).
9574
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009575 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9576 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9577 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9578 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9579 soft restart.
9580
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009581 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9582 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009583
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009584 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9585 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9586 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9587 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009588 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009589 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009590 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9591 if not expiration delay is specified.
9592
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009593 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9594 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9595 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9596 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009597 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9598 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9599 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9600 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9601 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9602 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9603 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9604 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9605 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9606 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9607 types and their arguments.
9608
9609 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9610 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9611 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9612 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9613
9614 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9615 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9616 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009617 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009618
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009619 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9620 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9621 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009622 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009623 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009624 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009625
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009626 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9627 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9628 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9629 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9630
9631 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9632 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9633 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9634 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9635 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9636 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9637
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009638 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9639 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9640 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9641 they were received.
9642
9643 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9644 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9645 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9646 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9647 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9648
9649 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9652 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9653 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9654
9655 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9656 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9657 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9658
9659 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9660 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9661 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9662 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9663 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9664
9665 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9666 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9667 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9668 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9669 the client side.
9670
9671 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9672 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9673 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9674 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9675 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9676 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9677 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9678
9679 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9680 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9681 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9682 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9683 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9684 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009685 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009686
9687 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9688 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9689 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9690 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9691 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9692 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9693
9694 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009695 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009696 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9697 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9698
9699 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9700 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9701 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9702 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9703 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9704 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9705 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9706 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9707 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9708 recommended for better fairness.
9709
9710 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009711 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009712 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9713 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9714
9715 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9716 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9717 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9718 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9719 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9720 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9721 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9722 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9723 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9724 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009725
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009726 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9727 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009728 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9729 reference it.
9730
9731 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9732 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009733 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9734 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9735 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009736
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009737 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9738 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9739 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9740 something that can be ignored.
9741
9742 Example:
9743 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9744 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9745 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9746 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9747
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009748 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009749 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009750
9751
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009752stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009753 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9755 no | no | yes | yes
9756
9757 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009758 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009759 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009760 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009761 server is selected.
9762
9763 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9764 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9765 the "stick-table" statement.
9766
9767 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9768 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9769 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9770 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9771
9772 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9773 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9774 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9775 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9776 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9777 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009778 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009779 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9780 rules.
9781
9782 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9783 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9784 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9785 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9786 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9787 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9788 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9789
9790 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9791 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9792 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9793 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9794
9795 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9796 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9797 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9798 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9799 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9800 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009801 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9802 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9803 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9804 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9805 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9806 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9807 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9808 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9809 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009810
9811 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9812
9813 Example :
9814 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9815 backend https
9816 mode tcp
9817 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009818 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009819 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009820
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009821 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9822 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9823
9824 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9825 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9826 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9827
9828 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9829 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009830
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009831 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9832 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9833 # at offset 44.
9834
9835 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9836 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9837
9838 # Learn on response if server hello.
9839 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009840
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009841 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9842 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9843
9844 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9845 extraction.
9846
9847
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009848tcp-check connect [params*]
9849 Opens a new connection
9850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9851 no | no | yes | yes
9852
9853 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9854 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9855 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9856
9857 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9858 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9859 of the sequence.
9860
9861 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9862 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9863 do.
9864
9865 Parameters :
9866 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9867 use the TCP connection.
9868
9869 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9870 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9871 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9872
9873 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9874
9875 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9876
9877 Examples:
9878 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9879 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9880 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9881 option tcp-check
9882 tcp-check connect
9883 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9884 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9885 tcp-check send \r\n
9886 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9887 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9888 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9889 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9890 tcp-check send \r\n
9891 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9892 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9893
9894 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9895 option tcp-check
9896 tcp-check connect port 110
9897 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9898 tcp-check connect port 143
9899 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9900 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9901
9902 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9903
9904
9905tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009906 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9908 no | no | yes | yes
9909
9910 Arguments :
9911 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9912 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9913 binary.
9914 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9915 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9916 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9917
9918 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9919 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9920 with the usual backslash ('\').
9921 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009922 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009923 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9924 used upper or lower case.
9925
9926
9927 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9928
9929 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9930 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9931 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9932 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9933 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9934 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9935 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9936 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9937
9938 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9939 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9940 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9941 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9942 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9943 expression.
9944
9945 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9946 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9947 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9948 this exact hexadecimal string.
9949 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9950
9951 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9952 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9953 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9954 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9955 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9956 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9957 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9958 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9959 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9960 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9961 the null character.
9962
9963 Examples :
9964 # perform a POP check
9965 option tcp-check
9966 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9967
9968 # perform an IMAP check
9969 option tcp-check
9970 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9971
9972 # look for the redis master server
9973 option tcp-check
9974 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009975 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009976 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9977 tcp-check expect string role:master
9978 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9979 tcp-check expect string +OK
9980
9981
9982 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9983 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9984
9985
9986tcp-check send <data>
9987 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9989 no | no | yes | yes
9990
9991 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9992 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9993
9994 Examples :
9995 # look for the redis master server
9996 option tcp-check
9997 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9998 tcp-check expect string role:master
9999
10000 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10001 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10002
10003
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10005 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010006 tcp health check
10007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10008 no | no | yes | yes
10009
10010 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10011 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010012 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010013 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10014 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10015 hexadecimal string.
10016 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10017
10018 Examples :
10019 # redis check in binary
10020 option tcp-check
10021 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10022 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10023
10024
10025 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10026 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10027
10028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010029tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10030 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010033 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010034 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10035 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010037 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010038
10039 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10040 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010041 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10042 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10043 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10044 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10045 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10046 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010048 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10049 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10050 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10051 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010052
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010053 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010054 - accept :
10055 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10056 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10057 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010059 - reject :
10060 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10061 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10062 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10063 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10064 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10065 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10066 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10067 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10068 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10069 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10070 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010071 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010072
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010073 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10074 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10075 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10076 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10077 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10078 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10079 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10080 hosts.
10081
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010082 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10083 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10084 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10085 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10086 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10087 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10088 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10089 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10090
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010091 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10092 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10093 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10094 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10095 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10096 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10097 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10098 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10099 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010100 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10101 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010102
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010103 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010104 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010105 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10106 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10107 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010108 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010109 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10110 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10111 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10112 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10113 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10114 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10115 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10116 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010118 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010119 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010121 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010122 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10123 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10124 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010126 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10127 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10128 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10129 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010131 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10132 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10133 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10134 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10135 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010136 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10137 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10138 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10139 layer7 information is extracted.
10140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010141 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10142 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10143 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10144 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10145 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010146
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010147 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10148 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10149 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10150 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10151
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010152 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10153 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10154 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10155 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10156
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010157 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10158 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10159 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10160 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10161 continues.
10162
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010163 - set-src <expr> :
10164 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10165 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10166 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010167 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010169 Arguments:
10170 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10171 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010172
10173 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010174 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10175
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010176 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10177 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010178
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010179 - set-src-port <expr> :
10180 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10181 expression.
10182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010183 Arguments:
10184 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10185 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010186
10187 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010188 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10189
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010190 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10191 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10192 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010193
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010194 - set-dst <expr> :
10195 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10196 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10197 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10198 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10199 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10200
10201 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10202 followed by some converters.
10203
10204 Example:
10205
10206 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10207 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10208
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010209 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10210 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10211
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010212 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10213 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10214 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10215 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10216
10217
10218 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10219 followed by some converters.
10220
10221 Example:
10222
10223 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10224
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010225 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10226 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10227 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10228
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010229 - "silent-drop" :
10230 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010231 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010232 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10233 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10234 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10235 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10236 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010237 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10238 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010239 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10240 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010241 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010242 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10243 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10244 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10245 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10246
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010247 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10248 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10249 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010251 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10252 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10253 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010255 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010256 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010257 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010259 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10260 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10261 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010263 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010264 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10265 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010266
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010267 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10268
10269 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10270
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010271 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10272
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010273 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010274
10275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010276tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10277 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010279 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010281 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10282 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010284 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010287 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10288 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10289 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10290 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10293 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10294 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10295 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010296 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10297 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10298 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10299 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10300 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10301 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010302 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010303 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010305 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10306 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10307 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10308 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010309
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010310 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010311 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010312 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010313 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10314 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010315 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010316 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010317 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010318 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010319 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010320 - set-dst <expr>
10321 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010322 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010323 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010324 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010326 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010327
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010328 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10329 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010330 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10331 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010332
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010333 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10334 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10335 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10336 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10337 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10338 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010340 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010341 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10342 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010343
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010344 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010345 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10346 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10347 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10348 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010349 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10350 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10351 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010352
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010353 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010354 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10355 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10356 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010357
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010358 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10359 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10360
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010361 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010362 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10363 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010364
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010365 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10366 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010370 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010371 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010372 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10374 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010375 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010376 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10377 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010378
10379 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10380 followed by some converters.
10381
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010382 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10383 <var-name>.
10384
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010385 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10386 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10387 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10388 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10389 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10390
10391 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10392 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10393 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10394 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10395 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10396 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10397 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10398 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10399 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10400 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10401 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10402
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010403 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10404 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10405 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10406 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10407 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10408
10409 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10410
10411 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10412
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010413 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10414 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10415 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10416 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10417 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10418 evaluated.
10419
10420 Example:
10421 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10422
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010423 Example:
10424
10425 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010426 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010427
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010428 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10430 # and reject everything else.
10431 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10432 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010433 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 tcp-request content reject
10435
10436 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010437 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10438 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10439 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010440 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010441
10442 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10443 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10444 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010445 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010446 tcp-request content reject
10447
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010448 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010449 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010450 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010451 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010452 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10453 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010454
10455 Example:
10456 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10457 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010458 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010459
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010460 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010461 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010462
10463 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010464 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010465 # protecting all our sites
10466 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010467 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10468 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010469 ...
10470 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10471
10472 backend http_dynamic
10473 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010474 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010475 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010476 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010477 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010478 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010479 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010481 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010482
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010483 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10484 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010485
10486
10487tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10488 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010490 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010491 Arguments :
10492 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10493 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10494 as explained at the top of this document.
10495
10496 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10497 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10498 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10499 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10500 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10501
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010502 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10503 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10504 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10505 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10506
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010507 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10508 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010509 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010510 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010511 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10512 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10513 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10514 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010515
10516 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10517 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10518 it pass through unaffected.
10519
10520 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10521 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10522 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010523 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010524 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10525 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010526 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10527 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10528 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010529
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010530 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010531 "timeout client".
10532
10533
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010534tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10535 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10537 no | no | yes | yes
10538 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010539 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10540 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010541
10542 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10543
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010544 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010545 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10546 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010547 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10548 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010549
10550 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10551
10552 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10553 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10554 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10555 inserted.
10556
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010557 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010558 - accept :
10559 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10560 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10561 the rules evaluation.
10562
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010563 - close :
10564 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10565 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10566 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10567 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10568 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10569 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010570 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010571 protocols.
10572
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010573 - reject :
10574 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10575 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010576 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010577
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010578 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10579 Sets a variable.
10580
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010581 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10582 Unsets a variable.
10583
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010584 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10585 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10586 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10587 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10588
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010589 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10590 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10592 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10593
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010594 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10595 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10596 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10597 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10598 continues.
10599
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010600 - "silent-drop" :
10601 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010602 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010603 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10604 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10605 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10606 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10607 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10609 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010610 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10611 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010613 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10614 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10615 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10616 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10617
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010618 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10619 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10620
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010621 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10622 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10623 for changing the default action to a reject.
10624
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010625 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10626 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10627 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10628 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010629 period.
10630
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010631 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10632 declared inline.
10633
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010634 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10635 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010636 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010637 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10638 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010639 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010640 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010641 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10643 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010645 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10646 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010647
10648 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10649 followed by some converters.
10650
10651 Example:
10652
10653 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10654
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010655 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10656 <var-name>.
10657
10658 Example:
10659
10660 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10661
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010662 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10663 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10664 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10665 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10666 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10667
10668 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10669
10670 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10671
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010672 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10673
10674 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10675
10676
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010677tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10678 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10680 no | yes | yes | no
10681 Arguments :
10682 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10683 below.
10684
10685 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10686
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010687 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010688 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10689 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10690 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10691 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10692 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10693 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10694 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010695 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010696 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10697 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10698 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10699 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10700 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10701 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10702 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10703 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10704 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10705 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10706 instead.
10707
10708 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10709 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10710 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10711 rules which may be inserted.
10712
10713 Several types of actions are supported :
10714 - accept : the request is accepted
10715 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10716 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10717 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010718 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010719 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10720 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010721 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010722 - silent-drop
10723
10724 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10725 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10726 sections for a complete description.
10727
10728 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10729 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10730 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10731
10732 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10733 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10734 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10735 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10736 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10737
10738 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10739 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10740
10741 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10742 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10743 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10744
10745 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10746 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10747 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10748
10749 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10750 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10751 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10752
10753 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10754 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10755 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10756
10757 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10758
10759 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10760
10761
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010762tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10763 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10765 no | no | yes | yes
10766 Arguments :
10767 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10769 as explained at the top of this document.
10770
10771 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10772
10773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010774timeout check <timeout>
10775 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10776 established.
10777
10778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10779 yes | no | yes | yes
10780 Arguments:
10781 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10782 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10783 as explained at the top of this document.
10784
10785 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10786 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010787 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010788 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010789 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10790 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10791 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010792
10793 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10794 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10795
10796 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10797 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010798 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010799
10800 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10801 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10802 forget about it.
10803
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010804 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10805 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010806
10807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010808timeout client <timeout>
10809timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10810 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 yes | yes | yes | no
10813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10816 as explained at the top of this document.
10817
10818 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10819 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10820 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010821 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10822 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10823 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10824 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010825 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10826 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10827 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010828 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010829 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010830 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10831 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010832 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10833 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010834
10835 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10836 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10837 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10838 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010839 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010840 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10841
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010842 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010844 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10845 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10846 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10847
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010848 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10849 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010850
10851
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010852timeout client-fin <timeout>
10853 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10855 yes | yes | yes | no
10856 Arguments :
10857 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10858 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10859 as explained at the top of this document.
10860
10861 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10862 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10863 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10864 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10865 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10866 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10867 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010868 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10869 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10870 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010871
10872 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10873 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10874 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10875
10876 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10877
10878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010879timeout connect <timeout>
10880timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10881 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10883 yes | no | yes | yes
10884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10887 as explained at the top of this document.
10888
10889 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010890 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010891 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010892 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010893 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10894 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010895
10896 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10897 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10898 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10899 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010900 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010901 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10902
10903 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10904 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10905 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10906
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010907 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10908 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010909
10910
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010911timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10912 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10914 yes | yes | yes | yes
10915 Arguments :
10916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10918 as explained at the top of this document.
10919
10920 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10921 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10922 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10923 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10924 once the request has started to present itself.
10925
10926 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10927 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10928 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10929 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10930 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10931
10932 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10933 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10934 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10935 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10936
10937 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10938 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010939 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010940 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10941 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010942 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010943
10944 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10945 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10946 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10947 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10948
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010949 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10950 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010951 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10952
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010953 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10954
10955
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010956timeout http-request <timeout>
10957 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010960 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010961 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010962 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10963 as explained at the top of this document.
10964
10965 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10966 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10967 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10968 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10969 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10970 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10971 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010972 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10973 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10974 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10975 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010977 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10978 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010979
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010980 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10981 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10982 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10983 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10984 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010985 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010986
10987 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10988 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010989 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010990 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10991 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10992
10993 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010994 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10995 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10996 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010997
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010998 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010999 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011000
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011001
11002timeout queue <timeout>
11003 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11005 yes | no | yes | yes
11006 Arguments :
11007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11009 as explained at the top of this document.
11010
11011 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11012 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11013 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11014 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11015 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11016
11017 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11018 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11019 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11020 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11021
11022 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11023
11024
11025timeout server <timeout>
11026timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11027 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11029 yes | no | yes | yes
11030 Arguments :
11031 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11033 as explained at the top of this document.
11034
11035 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11036 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11037 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11038 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11039 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11040 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11041 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11042
11043 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11044 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11045 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11046 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11047 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011048 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011049 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011050 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11051 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011052 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11053 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011054
11055 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11056 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11057 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11058 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011059 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011060 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11061
11062 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11063 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11064 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11065
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011066 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011067
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011068
11069timeout server-fin <timeout>
11070 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11072 yes | no | yes | yes
11073 Arguments :
11074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11076 as explained at the top of this document.
11077
11078 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11079 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11080 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11081 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11082 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11083 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11084 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11085 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11086 situations, it should not be needed.
11087
11088 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11089 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11090 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11091
11092 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11093
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011094
11095timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011096 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11098 yes | yes | yes | yes
11099 Arguments :
11100 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11102 as explained at the top of this document.
11103
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011104 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11105 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11106 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11107 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011108
11109 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11110 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11111 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11112 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011113 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011114
11115 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11116
11117
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011118timeout tunnel <timeout>
11119 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11121 yes | no | yes | yes
11122 Arguments :
11123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11125 as explained at the top of this document.
11126
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011127 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011128 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11129 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11130 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011131 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11132 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011133 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11134 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11135 specified.
11136
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011137 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11138 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11139 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11140 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11141 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11142 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11143 state.
11144
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011145 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11146 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11147 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11148 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011149 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011150
11151 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11152 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11153 forget about it.
11154
11155 Example :
11156 defaults http
11157 option http-server-close
11158 timeout connect 5s
11159 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011160 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011161 timeout server 30s
11162 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11163
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011164 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011165
11166
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011167transparent (deprecated)
11168 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011170 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011171 Arguments : none
11172
11173 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11174 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11175 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11176 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11177 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11178 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11179 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11180 appropriate server.
11181
11182 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11183
11184 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11185 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11186
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011187 See also: "option transparent"
11188
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011189unique-id-format <string>
11190 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11192 yes | yes | yes | no
11193 Arguments :
11194 <string> is a log-format string.
11195
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011196 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11197 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11198 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11199 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011200
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011201 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11202 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11203 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11204 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11205 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11206 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11207 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11208 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011210 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11211 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011212
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011213 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011214
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011215 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011216
11217 will generate:
11218
11219 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11220
11221 See also: "unique-id-header"
11222
11223unique-id-header <name>
11224 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11226 yes | yes | yes | no
11227 Arguments :
11228 <name> is the name of the header.
11229
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011230 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11231 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011232
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011233 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011234
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011235 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011236 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11237
11238 will generate:
11239
11240 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11241
11242 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011243
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011244use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011245 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11247 no | yes | yes | no
11248 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011249 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11250 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011252 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11253 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011254
11255 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11256 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11257 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011258 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011260 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11261 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011262
11263 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11264 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11265 assign the backend.
11266
11267 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11268 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11269 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11270 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11271 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11272 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11273
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011274 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011275 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011276 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11277 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11278 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11279
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011280 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11281 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11282 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11283 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11284 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11285 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11286 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11287 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11288 cannot be forced from the request.
11289
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011290 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011291 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11292 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11293
11294 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11295 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011296
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011297
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011298use-server <server> if <condition>
11299use-server <server> unless <condition>
11300 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11302 no | no | yes | yes
11303 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011304 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011305
11306 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11307
11308 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11309 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11310 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11311
11312 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11313 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11314 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11315 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11316 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11317 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11318 matches will assign the server.
11319
11320 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11321 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11322 with the next rules until one matches.
11323
11324 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11325 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11326 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11327 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11328
11329 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11330 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11331 stripped.
11332
11333 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11334 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11335 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11336 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11337
11338 Example :
11339 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11340 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11341 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11342 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11343 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11344 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011345 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011346 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11347 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11348
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011349 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113525. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011353--------------------------
11354
11355The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11356depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11357settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11358written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11359described in this section.
11360
11361
113625.1. Bind options
11363-----------------
11364
11365The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11366as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11367no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11368parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11369while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11370provided immediately after the setting name.
11371
11372The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11373
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011374accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11375 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11376 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11377 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11378 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11379 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11380 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11381 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11382 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11383 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011384 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11385 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11386 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011388accept-proxy
11389 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011390 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11391 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011392 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11393 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11394 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11395 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011397 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11398 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011399 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11400 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011401
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011402allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011403 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011404 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011405 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011406 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11407 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011408
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011409alpn <protocols>
11410 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11411 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11412 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011413 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011414 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011415 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11416 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11417 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11418 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11419 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11420 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11421 preference, like below :
11422
11423 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011424
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011425backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011426 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011427 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11428
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011429curves <curves>
11430 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11431 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11432 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11433 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11434 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11435 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11436
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011437ecdhe <named curve>
11438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011439 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11440 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011441
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011442ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11444 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11445 client's certificate.
11446
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011447ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11449 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11450 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11451 error is ignored.
11452
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011453ca-sign-file <cafile>
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11455 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11456 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11457 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11458 'generate-certificates' for details.
11459
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011460ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11462 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11463 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11464 'generate-certificates' for details.
11465
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011466ciphers <ciphers>
11467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11468 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011469 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011470 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011471 information and recommendations see e.g.
11472 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11473 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11474 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11475
11476ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11478 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11479 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11480 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011481 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11482 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011483
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011484crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11486 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11487 to verify client's certificate.
11488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011489crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11491 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11492 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11493 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11494 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11495 file.
11496
11497 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11498 are loaded.
11499
11500 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011501 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011502 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11503 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11504 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11505 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11507 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011508 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011509
11510 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11511 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11512 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11513 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011514 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11515 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011516
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011517 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011518
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011520 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011521 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11522 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011523 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11524 clients).
11525
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011526 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11527 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11528 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11529 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11530 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11531 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11532 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11533 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11534 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11535 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11536 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11537 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11538 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11539
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011540 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11541 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11542 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11543 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11544 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11545
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011546 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11547 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11548 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11549 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011550
11551 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11552 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11553 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11554 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11555 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11556 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11557 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11558 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11559 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11560
11561 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11562
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011563 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011564 a cert bundle.
11565
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011566 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011567 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11568 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11569 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11570 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11571 provide multi-cert support.
11572
11573 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11574
11575 Filename | CN | SAN
11576 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11577 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011578 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011579 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11580 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11581
11582 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11583 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11584 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11585 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011586 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11587 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11588 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011589
11590 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11591 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11592
11593 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11594 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11595 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11596
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011597crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011599 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011600 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011601 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011602
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011603crt-list <file>
11604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011605 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11606 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011607
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011608 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11609
William Lallemand0b77c182020-06-30 16:11:36 +020011610 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ciphers",
11611 "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names", "npn",
11612 "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
11613 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
11614 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011615
William Lallemandb0b703f2020-10-06 17:06:11 +020011616 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filters can be specified
11617 in the configuration, but they are only used as a hint, they don't do
11618 anything. (this changes in newer haproxy versions) If you want to exclude a
11619 SNI from a wildcard, use this positive SNI on another line. (like in the
11620 example).
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011621 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11622 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11623 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11624 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11625 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11626 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011627
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011628 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011629 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011630 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11631 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11632 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011633
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011634 crt-list file example:
11635 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011636 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011637 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011638 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011639
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011640defer-accept
11641 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11642 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11643 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011644 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011645 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11646 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11647 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11648 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11649 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11650 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11651 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11652
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011653expose-fd listeners
11654 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11655 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011656 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11657 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011658 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011659
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011660force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011661 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011662 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011663 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011665
11666force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011668 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011669 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011670
11671force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011673 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011675
11676force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011680
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011681force-tlsv13
11682 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11683 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011684 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011685
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011686generate-certificates
11687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11688 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11689 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11690 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11691 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11692 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11693 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11694 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11695 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11696 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11697 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11698
11699 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11700 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011701 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011702 certificate is used many times.
11703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011704gid <gid>
11705 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11706 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11707 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11708 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11709 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11710
11711group <group>
11712 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11713 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11714 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11715 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11716 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11717
11718id <id>
11719 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11720 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11721 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11722 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11723
11724interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011725 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11726 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11727 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11728 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11729 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11730 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011731 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11732 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11733 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11734 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11735 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11736 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011737
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011738level <level>
11739 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11740 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11741 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011742 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011743 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11744 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11745 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011746 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011747 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011748 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011749 all counters).
11750
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011751severity-output <format>
11752 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11753 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11754 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11755 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11756 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11757 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11758 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11759 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11760 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11761 rfc5424 convention.
11762
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011763maxconn <maxconn>
11764 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11765 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11766 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11767 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11768 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11769 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11770 eat all memory.
11771
11772mode <mode>
11773 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11774 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11775 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11776 UNIX sockets.
11777
11778mss <maxseg>
11779 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11780 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11781 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11782 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11783 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11784 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11785 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11786 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11787 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11788 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11789 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11790
11791name <name>
11792 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11793 page.
11794
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011795namespace <name>
11796 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11797 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11798 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11799 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11800
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011801nice <nice>
11802 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11803 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11804 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11805 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11806 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11807 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11808 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11809 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11810 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11811 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11812 one for an RDP socket.
11813
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011814no-ca-names
11815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11816 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11817
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011818no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011820 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011821 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011822 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011823 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11824 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011825
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011826no-tls-tickets
11827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11828 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11829 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011830 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11831 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011832 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11833 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11834 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011835
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011836no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011838 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011839 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011840 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011841 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11842 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011843
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011844no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011846 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011847 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011848 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011849 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11850 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011851
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011852no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011854 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011855 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011856 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011857 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11858 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011859
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011860no-tlsv13
11861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11862 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11863 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11864 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011865 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11866 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011867
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011868npn <protocols>
11869 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11870 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11871 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011872 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011873 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011874 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11875 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11876 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11877 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11878 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011879
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011880prefer-client-ciphers
11881 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11882 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11883 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011884 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11885 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11886 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011887
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011888process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011889 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011890 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011892 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11893 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11894 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11895 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011896 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011897 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11898 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11899 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11900 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11901 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011902
11903 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11904
11905 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11906 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11907 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11908 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11909 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11910 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11911 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11912 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011913
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011914proto <name>
11915 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11916 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11917 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11918 in haproxy -vv.
11919 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11920 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011921 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011922 h2" on the bind line.
11923
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011924ssl
11925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011926 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011927 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11928 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011929 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11930 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011931
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011932ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11933 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11934 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11935 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11936
11937ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11938 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11939 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11940 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11941
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011942strict-sni
11943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11944 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11945 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11946 See the "crt" option for more information.
11947
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011948tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011949 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011950 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11951 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011952 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011953 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11954 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11955 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11956 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11957 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11958 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11959 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11960
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011961tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011962 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011963 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11964 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11965 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11966 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11967 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11968 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11969 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011970 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11971 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11972 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011973
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011974tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11975 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011976 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11977 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11978 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11979 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11980 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11981 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11982 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11983 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11984 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11985 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011986 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11987 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11988
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011989transparent
11990 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11991 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11992 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11993 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11994 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11995 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11996 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11997 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11998 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11999 so check for support with your vendor.
12000
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012001v4v6
12002 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12003 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12004 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12005 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012006 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012007
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012008v6only
12009 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12010 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12011 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012012 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12013 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012014
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012015uid <uid>
12016 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12017 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12018 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12019 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12020 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12021
12022user <user>
12023 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12024 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12025 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12026 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12027 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12028
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012029verify [none|optional|required]
12030 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12031 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12032 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12033 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12034 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012035 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12036 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12037 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12038 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012039
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120405.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012041------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012043The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12044which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12045arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12046settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12047after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12048Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12049address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012051 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012052 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012053
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012054Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12055keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012057The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012058
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012059addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012060 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012061 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12062 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12063 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12064 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12065 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012066
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012067agent-check
12068 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012069 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012070 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12071 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12072 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012074 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012075 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012076 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12077 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12078 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012080 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12081 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12082 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12083 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12084 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012086 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012087 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012088
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012089 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12090 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12091 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012093 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12094 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12095 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012096
William Dauchyd58def32020-09-26 13:35:51 +020012097 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012098 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12099 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12100 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12101 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012102 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012103 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012105 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12106 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012107
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012108 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12109 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12110 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12111 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12112 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12113 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12114 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12115 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12116 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012117
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012118 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12119 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012120 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12121 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12122 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012123 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012124
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012125 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012126 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012127
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012128agent-send <string>
12129 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12130 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12131 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12132 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12133 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12134
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012135agent-inter <delay>
12136 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12137 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12138
12139 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12140 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12141 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12142 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12143 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12144 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12145 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12146 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12147 of backends use the same servers.
12148
12149 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12150
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012151agent-addr <addr>
12152 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12153
12154 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12155 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12156 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12157 hostname, it will be resolved.
12158
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012159agent-port <port>
12160 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12161
12162 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12163
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012164allow-0rtt
12165 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012166 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12167 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012168
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012169alpn <protocols>
12170 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12171 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12172 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012173 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012174 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12175 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12176 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12177 now obsolete NPN extension.
12178 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12179 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12180
12181 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012183backup
12184 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12185 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12186 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12187 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012188 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12189 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012190
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012191ca-file <cafile>
12192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12193 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12194 server's certificate.
12195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012196check
12197 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012198 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12199 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12200 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12201 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12202 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12203 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12204 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012205 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12206 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012207 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12208 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012209
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012210check-send-proxy
12211 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12212 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12213 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12214 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12215 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12216 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12217 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12218
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012219check-alpn <protocols>
12220 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12221 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12222 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12223
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012224check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012225 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012226 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12227 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012228
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012229check-ssl
12230 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12231 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12232 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12233 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012234 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012235 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12236 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012238 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12239 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012240
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012241check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012242 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012243 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12244 for normal traffic.
12245
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012246ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12248 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12249 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012250 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12251 information and recommendations see e.g.
12252 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12253 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12254 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012255
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012256ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12258 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12259 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12260 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012261 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12262 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12263 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012265cookie <value>
12266 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12267 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12268 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12269 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12270 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12271 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12272 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12273
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012274crl-file <crlfile>
12275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12276 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12277 to verify server's certificate.
12278
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012279crt <cert>
12280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12281 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12282 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12283 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12284 certificate request.
12285
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012286disabled
12287 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12288 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12289 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12290 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12291 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012292 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012293
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012294enabled
12295 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12296 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12297 default value.
12298 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12299 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012301error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012302 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12303 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12304 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012306 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012308fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012309 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12310 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12311 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12312
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012313force-sslv3
12314 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12315 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012316 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012317 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012318
12319force-tlsv10
12320 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012321 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012323
12324force-tlsv11
12325 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012326 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012327 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012328
12329force-tlsv12
12330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012331 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012333
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012334force-tlsv13
12335 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12336 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012337 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012339id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012340 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12341 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12342 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012343
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012344init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12345 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12346 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012347 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012348 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12349 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12350 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12351 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12352 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12353 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12354 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12355 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12356 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012357 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012358 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12359 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12360 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12361 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12362 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12363 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012364 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012365
12366 Example:
12367 defaults
12368 # never fail on address resolution
12369 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012371inter <delay>
12372fastinter <delay>
12373downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012374 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12375 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12376 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12377 between checks depending on the server state :
12378
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012379 Server state | Interval used
12380 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12381 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12382 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12383 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12384 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12385 or yet unchecked. |
12386 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12387 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12388 | "inter" otherwise.
12389 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012391 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12392 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12393 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12394 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012395 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12396 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12397 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12398 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12399 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012401maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012402 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12403 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012404 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12405 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012406 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12407 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12408 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12409 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12410
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012411 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12412 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12413 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12414 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12415 than 50 concurrent requests.
12416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012417maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012418 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12419 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12420 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12421 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12422 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12423 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12424 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12425
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012426max-reuse <count>
12427 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12428 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12429 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12430 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12431 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12432 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12433 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12434 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012436minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012437 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12438 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12439 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12440 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12441 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12442 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012443 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012444 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012445
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012446namespace <name>
12447 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12448 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12449 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12450 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12451
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012452no-agent-check
12453 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12454 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12455 default value.
12456 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12457 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12458
12459no-backup
12460 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12461 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12462 default value.
12463 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12464 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12465
12466no-check
12467 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12468 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12469 default value.
12470 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12471 "default-server" "check" setting.
12472
12473no-check-ssl
12474 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12475 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12476 default value.
12477 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12478 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12479
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012480no-send-proxy
12481 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12482 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12483 default value.
12484 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12485 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12486
12487no-send-proxy-v2
12488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12490 default value.
12491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12492 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12493
12494no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12497 default value.
12498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12499 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12500
12501no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12502 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12503 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12504 default value.
12505 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12506 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12507
12508no-ssl
12509 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12510 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12511 default value.
12512 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12513 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12514
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012515no-ssl-reuse
12516 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12517 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12518 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12519 and for paranoid users.
12520
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012521no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012522 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12523 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012524 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012525
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012526 Supported in default-server: No
12527
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012528no-tls-tickets
12529 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12530 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12531 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012532 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12533 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012534 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12535 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12536 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012537 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012538
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012539no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012540 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012541 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12542 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012543 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12544 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012545 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012546
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012547 Supported in default-server: No
12548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012549no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012550 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012551 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12552 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012553 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12554 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012555 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012556
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012557 Supported in default-server: No
12558
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012559no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012560 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012561 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12562 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012563 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12564 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012565 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012566
12567 Supported in default-server: No
12568
12569no-tlsv13
12570 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12571 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12572 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12573 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12574 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012575 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012576
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012577 Supported in default-server: No
12578
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012579no-verifyhost
12580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12582 default value.
12583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12584 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012585
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012586no-tfo
12587 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12588 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12589 default value.
12590 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12591 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12592
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012593non-stick
12594 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12595 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12596 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12597
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012598npn <protocols>
12599 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12600 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12601 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012602 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012603 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12604 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12605 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012607observe <mode>
12608 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12609 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12610 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12611 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12612 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12613 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012614 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012615
12616 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012618on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012619 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12620 Currently, four modes are available:
12621 - fastinter: force fastinter
12622 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12623 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12624 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12625 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12626
12627 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12628
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012629on-marked-down <action>
12630 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12631 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012632 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12633 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12634 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12635 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12636 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12637 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12638 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12639 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012640
12641 Actions are disabled by default
12642
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012643on-marked-up <action>
12644 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12645 Currently one action is available:
12646 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12647 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12648 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12649 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012650 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12651 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012652 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12653 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12654
12655 Actions are disabled by default
12656
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012657pool-max-conn <max>
12658 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12659 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12660 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12661 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12662 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12663 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12664
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012665pool-purge-delay <delay>
12666 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012667 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012668 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012670port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012671 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12672 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12673 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12674 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12675 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12676 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12677
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012678proto <name>
12679
12680 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12681 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12682 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12683 reported in haproxy -vv.
12684 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12685 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012687redir <prefix>
12688 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12689 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12690 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12691 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12692 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12693 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12694 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12695 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012696 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012697 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012698 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12699 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12700 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12701 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12702
12703 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012705rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012706 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12707 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12708 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12709
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012710resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12711 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12712 server.
12713
12714 Available options:
12715
12716 * allow-dup-ip
12717 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12718 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12719 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12720 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12721 For such case, simply enable this option.
12722 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12723
12724 * prevent-dup-ip
12725 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12726 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12727 same fqdn.
12728 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12729
12730 Example:
12731 backend b_myapp
12732 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12733 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12734 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12735
12736 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12737 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12738 it
12739 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12740 different address
12741
12742 Default value: not set
12743
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012744resolve-prefer <family>
12745 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12746 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12747 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12748 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12749
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012750 Default value: ipv6
12751
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012752 Example:
12753
12754 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012755
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012756resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012757 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012758 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012759 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012760 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12761 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012762 configured network, another address is selected.
12763
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012764 Example:
12765
12766 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012767
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012768resolvers <id>
12769 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12770 hostname.
12771
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012772 Example:
12773
12774 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012775
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012776 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012777
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012778send-proxy
12779 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12780 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12781 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12782 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012783 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12784 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12785 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12786 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12787 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12788 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12789 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12790 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12791 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12792 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012793 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12794 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012795
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012796send-proxy-v2
12797 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12798 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12799 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12800 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012801 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12802 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12803 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12804 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012805
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012806proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12807 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12808 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012809 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12810 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012811 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12812 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012813 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012814
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012815send-proxy-v2-ssl
12816 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12817 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12818 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12819 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12820 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12821 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12822 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012823 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12824 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012825
12826send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12827 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12828 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12829 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12830 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12831 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12832 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12833 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12834 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012835 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12836 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012838slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012839 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12840 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12841 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12842 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12843 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12844 parameters :
12845
12846 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12847 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12848
12849 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12850 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12851 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12852 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12853
12854 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12855 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12856 seen as failed.
12857
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012858sni <expression>
12859 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12860 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12861 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12862 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012863 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12864 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012865 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012866 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12867 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012868
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012869source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012870source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012871source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012872 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12873 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12874 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12875 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12876
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012877 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12878 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12879 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12880 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12881 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12882 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12883 server.
12884
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012885 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12886 specifying the source address without port(s).
12887
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012888ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012889 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12890 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12891 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12892 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12893 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12894 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012895 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12896 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012897
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012898ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12899 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12900 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12902
12903ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12904 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12905 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12906 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12907
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012908ssl-reuse
12909 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12910 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12911 default value.
12912 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12913 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12914
12915stick
12916 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12917 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12918 default value.
12919 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12920 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012921
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012922socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012923 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012924 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12925 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12926
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012927tcp-ut <delay>
12928 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12929 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12930 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012931 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012932 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12933 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12934 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12935 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12936 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12937 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12938 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12939 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12940 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12941
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012942tfo
12943 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12944 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12945 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12946 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12947 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012948 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012950track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012951 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12952 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12953 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12954 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012955 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12956
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012957tls-tickets
12958 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12959 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12960 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012961 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12962 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12963 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012964 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012965 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012966
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012967verify [none|required]
12968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012969 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012970 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12971 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012972 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012973 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12974 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12975 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12976 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12977 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12978 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12979 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12980 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012981
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012982verifyhost <hostname>
12983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012984 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12985 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12986 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12987 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12988 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12989 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12990 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12991 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012993weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012994 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12995 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12996 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012997 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12998 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12999 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13000 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13001 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13002 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013003
13004
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130055.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13006-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013007
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013008HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13009using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070013010configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013011This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13012can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13013workload.
13014This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13015resolution at run time.
13016Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13017carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13018
13019
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130205.3.1. Global overview
13021----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013022
13023As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13024different steps of the process life:
13025
13026 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13027 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13028 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13029
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013030 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13031 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013032
13033A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13034 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13035 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13036 resolution to know this new IP.
13037
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013038When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013039HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013040SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13041from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13042will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13043will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013044
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013045A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013046 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013047 first valid response.
13048
13049 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13050 servers return an error.
13051
13052
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130535.3.2. The resolvers section
13054----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013055
13056This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013057HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13058contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013059
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013060When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13061uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13062is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13063answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13064
13065When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013066used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013067
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013068 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13069 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13070 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013071
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013072 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13073 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013074
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013075 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13076 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13077 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013078
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013079For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13080following scenarios are possible:
13081
13082 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13083 ignored
13084
13085 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13086 applied
13087
13088 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13089 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13090
13091 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13092 retries the query with a new type
13093
13094 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13095 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013096
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013097As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13098a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013099<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013100
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013101
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013102resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013104
13105A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13106
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013107accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013109 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013110 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13111 by RFC 6891)
13112
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013113 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13114
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013115nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13116 DNS server description:
13117 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13118 <ip> : IP address of the server
13119 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13120
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013121parse-resolv-conf
13122 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13123 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13124 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13125
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013126hold <status> <period>
13127 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13128 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013129 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013130 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013131 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13132 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13133 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13134
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013135 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013136
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013137resolve_retries <nb>
13138 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13139 giving up.
13140 Default value: 3
13141
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013142 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13143 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13144 type.
13145
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013146timeout <event> <time>
13147 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13148 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13149 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013150 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13151 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013152 Default value: 1s
13153 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013154 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013155 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013156 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13157 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13158
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013159 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013160
13161 resolvers mydns
13162 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13163 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013164 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013165 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013166 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013167 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013168 hold other 30s
13169 hold refused 30s
13170 hold nx 30s
13171 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013172 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013173 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013174
13175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131766. HTTP header manipulation
13177---------------------------
13178
13179In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13180response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13181request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13182which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013183against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013184
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013185If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13186to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13187but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13188HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13189stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13190because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13191a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13192still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013194This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13195in section 4.2 :
13196
13197 - reqadd <string>
13198 - reqallow <search>
13199 - reqiallow <search>
13200 - reqdel <search>
13201 - reqidel <search>
13202 - reqdeny <search>
13203 - reqideny <search>
13204 - reqpass <search>
13205 - reqipass <search>
13206 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13207 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13208 - reqtarpit <search>
13209 - reqitarpit <search>
13210 - rspadd <string>
13211 - rspdel <search>
13212 - rspidel <search>
13213 - rspdeny <search>
13214 - rspideny <search>
13215 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13216 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13217
13218With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13219is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13220parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13221prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13222Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13223
13224 \t for a tab
13225 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13226 \n for a new line (LF)
13227 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13228 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13229 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13230 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13231 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13232
13233The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13234portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13235above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13236regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132379 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13238is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13239
13240The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13241after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13242
13243Notes related to these keywords :
13244---------------------------------
13245 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13246 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13247 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13248
13249 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13250 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13251 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13252
13253 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13254 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13255 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13256 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13257 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13258
13259 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13260 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13261 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13262 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13263 useless headers before adding new ones.
13264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013265 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013266 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13267
13268 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13269 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13270 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13271
13272 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13273 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013274 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013275
13276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13278----------------------------------
13279
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13282The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13283these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13284but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13285data called patterns.
13286
13287
132887.1. ACL basics
13289---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013290
13291The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13292content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13293from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13294simple :
13295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013297 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13299 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13302adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013303
13304In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013306 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013307
13308This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13309Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13310and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013311an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13312conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13313as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13314are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013315
13316ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13317'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13318which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13319
13320There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13321performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13324specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13325this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013326methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13327ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328
13329Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13330 - boolean
13331 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13332 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13333 - string
13334 - data block
13335
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013336Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13337converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13338would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13339The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13340which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13341
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013342Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13343keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13344fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13345which are summarized in the table below :
13346
13347 +---------------------+-----------------+
13348 | Sample or converter | Default |
13349 | output type | matching method |
13350 +---------------------+-----------------+
13351 | boolean | bool |
13352 +---------------------+-----------------+
13353 | integer | int |
13354 +---------------------+-----------------+
13355 | ip | ip |
13356 +---------------------+-----------------+
13357 | string | str |
13358 +---------------------+-----------------+
13359 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13360 +---------------------+-----------------+
13361
13362Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13363matching method, see below.
13364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13366 - boolean
13367 - integer or integer range
13368 - IP address / network
13369 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13370 - regular expression
13371 - hex block
13372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013373The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13374
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013375 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13376 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013378 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013379 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013380 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013381 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13384read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13385if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13386lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13387will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13388beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13389a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13390lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13391exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13392
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013393The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13394parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13395ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13396a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13397check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13398
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013399The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13400socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13401file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13404loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13405
13406 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13407
13408In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13409the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13410case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13411as well.
13412
13413The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13414sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13415do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13416methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13417is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013418obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013419followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13420default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13421that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13422string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13423
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013424The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13425By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13426string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13427resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13428server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013429waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013430flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13431function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13434sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13435be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013436
13437 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13438 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13440 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13441 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13442 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013443
13444 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13445 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013447
13448 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013450
13451 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013455 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13456
13457 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13458 binary or string samples.
13459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13461 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13464 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13465 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13468 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13471 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13474 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13477 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013478 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013480 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13481 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13482 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013483
13484For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13485request, it is possible to do :
13486
13487 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13488
13489In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13490buffer, one would use the following acl :
13491
13492 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13493
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013494On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13495possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13496
13497 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13500criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13501method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13502to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13503criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13504the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013506If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013507the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13508For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13511 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13512 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13513 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013514
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013515
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013516The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13517types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13518combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13519brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13520default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522 +-------------------------------------------------+
13523 | Input sample type |
13524 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013525 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13527 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13528 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013529 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013531 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013533 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013535 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013537 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013539 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013541 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013543 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013545 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013547 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013549 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13551 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013553
13554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135557.1.1. Matching booleans
13556------------------------
13557
13558In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13559Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13560When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13561that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13562
13563Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13564return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13565"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135687.1.2. Matching integers
13569------------------------
13570
13571Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13572enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13573to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13574
13575Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13576matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13577lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013578
13579For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13580unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13581representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13582
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013583As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13584two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13585instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13586ranges and operators.
13587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013588For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013589operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13590Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13591of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013593Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013594
13595 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13596 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13597 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13598 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13599 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013601For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013602
13603 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13604
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013605This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13606
13607 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136107.1.3. Matching strings
13611-----------------------
13612
13613String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13614different forms :
13615
13616 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013618
13619 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013620 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013621
13622 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13623 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13624
13625 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13626 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13627
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013628 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013629 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13630 matches.
13631
13632 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13633 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13634 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013635
13636String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13637exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13638characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13639string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13640to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013641before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013642
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013643Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13644(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13645Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13646
13647Example:
13648 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13649 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136527.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13653---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013654
13655Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13656they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13657possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13658passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13659the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013660the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13661match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013662
13663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136647.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13665-------------------------------------
13666
13667It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13668not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13669a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13670to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13671digits may be used upper or lower case.
13672
13673Example :
13674 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13675 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13676
13677
136787.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13679---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013680
13681IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13682netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13683within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013684host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013685difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13686at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13687does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13688parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013689
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013690The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13691abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13692
13693 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13694 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13695 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13696 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13697 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13698 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13699 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13700 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13701
13702Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13703192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13704
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013705IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13706Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13707trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13708IPv6 patterns.
13709
13710HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13711following situations :
13712 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13713 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13714 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13715 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13716 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13717 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13718 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13719 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13720 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13721 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723
137247.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13725----------------------------------
13726
13727Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13728combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13729
13730 - AND (implicit)
13731 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13732 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013736 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13739indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013741For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13742"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13743requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13744is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13745
13746 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013747 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13748 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13749 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013750
13751To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13752and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13753
13754 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13755 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13756 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13757 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013759 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13761 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13762 use_backend www if host_www
13763
13764It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13765expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13766be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13767the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13768
13769 The following rule :
13770
13771 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013772 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013773
13774 Can also be written that way :
13775
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013776 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777
13778It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13779to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13780simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13781sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13782good use is the following :
13783
13784 With named ACLs :
13785
13786 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13787 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13788 monitor fail if site_dead
13789
13790 With anonymous ACLs :
13791
13792 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13793
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013794See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13795keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796
13797
137987.3. Fetching samples
13799---------------------
13800
13801Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13802against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13803sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13804ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13805of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13806available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13807
13808This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13809Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13810compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13811deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13812
13813The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13814matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13815method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13816indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13817
13818As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13819when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13820mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13821the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13822ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13823
13824Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13825multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13826when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013827incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13828are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013829is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13830all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13831
13832Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13833 - name
13834 - name(arg1)
13835 - name(arg1,arg2)
13836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013837
138387.3.1. Converters
13839-----------------
13840
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013841Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13842of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13843is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13844was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013846unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13847
13848These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13849sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13850the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013852
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013853A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13854support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13855supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13856(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13857bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013859The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013860
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001386151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13862 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13863 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13864 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13865 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13866 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13867
13868 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013869 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13870 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013871 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13872 frontend http-in
13873 bind *:8081
13874 default_backend servers
13875 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13876 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13877
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013878add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013879 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013880 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013881 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13882 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13885 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13886 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13887 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013888 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013889 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013891aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13892 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13893 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13894 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13895 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13896 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13897 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13898
13899 Example:
13900 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13901 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13902
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013903and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013904 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013905 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013906 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13907 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013908 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013909 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13910 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13911 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13912 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013914 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013915
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013916b64dec
13917 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13918 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13919
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013920base64
13921 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013922 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013923 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13924
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013925bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013926 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013927 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013928 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013929 presence of a flag).
13930
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013931bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13932 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13933 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013934 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013935
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013936concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13937 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13938 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13939 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13940 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13941 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13942 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13943 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13944 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13945 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13946 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013947 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013948 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013949 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013950
13951 Example:
13952 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13953 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13954 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13955 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13956
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013957cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013958 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13959 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013960
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013961crc32([<avalanche>])
13962 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13963 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13964 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13965 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13966 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13967 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13968 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13969 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13970 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13971 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013972 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13973
13974crc32c([<avalanche>])
13975 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13976 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13977 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13978 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13979 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13980 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13981 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13982 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013983
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013984da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013985 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13986 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13987 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13988 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013989 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013990 configuration language.
13991
13992 Example:
13993 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013994 bind *:8881
13995 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013996 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013997
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013998debug
13999 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
14000 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
14001 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
14002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014003div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014004 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14005 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014006 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014007 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14008 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014009 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014010 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14011 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14012 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14013 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014015 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014016
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014017djb2([<avalanche>])
14018 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14019 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14020 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14021 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14022 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14023 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14024 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014025 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14026 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014027
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014028even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014029 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014030 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14031
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014032field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14033 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14034 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14035 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14036 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14037 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14038 fields.
14039
14040 Example :
14041 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14042 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14043 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14044 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14045 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014047hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014048 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014049 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014050 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014051 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014052
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014053hex2i
14054 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014055 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014057http_date([<offset>])
14058 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14059 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14060 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14061 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14062 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14063 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014065in_table(<table>)
14066 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14067 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14068 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014069 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014070 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14071
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014072ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14073 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014074 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014075 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14076 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14077 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14078 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14079 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014080
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014081json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014082 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014083 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014084 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014085 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14086 of errors:
14087 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14088 bytes, ...)
14089 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14090 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14091
14092 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14093 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14094 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14095 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14096 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14097 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014098 - "ascii" : never fails;
14099 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14100 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014101 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014103 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14104 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14105
14106 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014107 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014108
14109 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014110 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014111 capture request header user-agent len 150
14112 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014113
14114 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14115 GET / HTTP/1.0
14116 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14117
14118 Output log:
14119 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014121language(<value>[,<default>])
14122 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14123 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14124 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14125 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14126 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14127 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14128 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14129 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14130 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014131 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014132 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14133 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014135 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014137 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14138 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014139
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014140 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14141 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14142 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14143 use_backend spanish if es
14144 use_backend french if fr
14145 use_backend english if en
14146 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014147
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014148length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014149 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14150 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14151 type. The result is of type integer.
14152
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014153lower
14154 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14155 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14156 type. The result is of type string.
14157
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014158ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14159 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14160 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14161 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14162 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14163 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14164 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14165
14166 Example :
14167
14168 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014169 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014170 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014172map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14173map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14174map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14175 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14176 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14177 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14178 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14179 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14180 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14181 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14182 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014183
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014184 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14185 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14186 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014187
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014188 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014189 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014191 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14192 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14193 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14194 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014195 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14196 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014197 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14198 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14199 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14200 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14201 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14203 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14204 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014205 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14207 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14209 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14211 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014213
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014214 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14215 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14216 the corresponding match text.
14217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014218 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14219 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14220 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14221 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14222 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014224 Example :
14225
14226 # this is a comment and is ignored
14227 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14228 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14229 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14230 | | | `---------- value
14231 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14232 | `---------------------------- key
14233 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14234
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014235mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014236 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14237 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014238 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014239 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014240 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014241 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14242 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14243 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14244 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014245 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014246 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014247
14248mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014249 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014250 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14251 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014252 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014253 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014254 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014255 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14256 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14257 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14258 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014260 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014261
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014262nbsrv
14263 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14264 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14265 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14266 map lookup.
14267
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014268neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014269 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14270 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14271 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14272 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014273
14274not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014275 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014276 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014277 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014278 absence of a flag).
14279
14280odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014281 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014282 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14283
14284or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014285 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014286 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014287 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14288 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014289 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014290 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14291 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14292 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014294 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014295 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014296
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014297protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14298 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14299 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14300 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14301 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14302 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14303 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14304 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14305 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14306 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14307 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14308 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14309
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014310regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014311 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14312 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14313 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14314 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14315 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14316 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14317 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14318 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14319 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14320 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014321 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14322 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14323 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14324 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014325
14326 Example :
14327
14328 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14329 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14330 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14331 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14332
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014333capture-req(<id>)
14334 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14335 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14336
14337 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014338 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14339 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014340
14341capture-res(<id>)
14342 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14343 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14344
14345 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014346 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14347 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014349sdbm([<avalanche>])
14350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14358 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014360set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014361 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14362 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14363 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014364 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014365 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14366 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014367 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014372
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014373sha1
14374 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14375 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14376
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014377strcmp(<var>)
14378 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14379 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14380 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14381 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14382 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14383 shorter).
14384
14385 Example :
14386
14387 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14388 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14389 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14390
14391
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014392sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014393 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14394 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014395 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014396 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14397 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014398 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014399 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14400 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014401 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014402 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14403 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014405 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014406
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014407table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14411 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14412 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14413 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14414
14415
14416table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14417 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14418 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14419 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14420 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14421 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14422 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14423
14424table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014427 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014428 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14429 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14430
14431table_conn_cur(<table>)
14432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14434 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14435 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14436 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14437
14438table_conn_rate(<table>)
14439 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14440 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14441 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14442 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14443 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14444
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014445table_gpt0(<table>)
14446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14449 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14450 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14451
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014452table_gpc0(<table>)
14453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14456 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14457 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14458
14459table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14462 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14463 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14464 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14465 sample fetch keyword.
14466
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014467table_gpc1(<table>)
14468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14470 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14471 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14472 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14473
14474table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14475 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14476 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14477 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14478 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14479 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14480 sample fetch keyword.
14481
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014482table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014486 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14487 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14488
14489table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14492 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14493 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14494 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14495 keyword.
14496
14497table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14498 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14499 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014500 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014501 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14502 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14503
14504table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14505 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14506 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14507 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14508 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14509 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14510 keyword.
14511
14512table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14513 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14514 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014515 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014516 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14517 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14518 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14519 keyword.
14520
14521table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14522 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14523 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014524 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014525 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14526 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14527 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14528 keyword.
14529
14530table_server_id(<table>)
14531 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14532 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14533 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14534 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14535 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14536 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14537
14538table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14539 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14540 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014541 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014542 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14543 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14544 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14545 keyword.
14546
14547table_sess_rate(<table>)
14548 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14549 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14550 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14551 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14552 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14553 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14554 keyword.
14555
14556table_trackers(<table>)
14557 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14558 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14559 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14560 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14561 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14562 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14563 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14564 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14565 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14566 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14567
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014568upper
14569 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14570 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14571 type. The result is of type string.
14572
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014573url_dec([<in_form>])
14574 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14575 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14576 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14577 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14578 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14579 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014580
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014581ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014582 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014583 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14584 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14585 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014586 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14587 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14588 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14589 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014590 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014591 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14592 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014593
14594 Example:
14595 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14596 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14597
14598 message Point {
14599 int32 latitude = 1;
14600 int32 longitude = 2;
14601 }
14602
14603 message PPoint {
14604 Point point = 59;
14605 }
14606
14607 message Rectangle {
14608 // One corner of the rectangle.
14609 PPoint lo = 48;
14610 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14611 PPoint hi = 49;
14612 }
14613
14614 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14615 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14616 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14617
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014618 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14619 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014620 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014621 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14622
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014623 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014624
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014625 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014626
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014627 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014628 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14629 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14630
14631 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14632 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14633 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14634
14635 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14636 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14637 interpret the previous binary sample.
14638
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014639
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014640unset-var(<var name>)
14641 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14642 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14643 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14644 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14645 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14646 response),
14647 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14648 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14649 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14650 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14651
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014652utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14653 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14654 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14655 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14656 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14657 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14658 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14659
14660 Example :
14661
14662 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014663 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014664 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14665
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014666word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14667 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14668 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14669 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014670 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014671 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14672 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14673
14674 Example :
14675 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14676 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14677 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14678 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14679 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014680 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014681
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014682wt6([<avalanche>])
14683 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14684 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14685 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14686 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14687 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14688 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14689 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014690 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14691 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014693xor(<value>)
14694 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014695 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014696 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014697 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014701 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14703 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014704 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014705 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014706
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014707xxh32([<seed>])
14708 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14709 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14710 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14711 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14712 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14713 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14714 as cryptographically secure.
14715
14716xxh64([<seed>])
14717 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14718 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14719 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14720 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14721 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14722 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14723 as cryptographically secure.
14724
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014725
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147267.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014727--------------------------------------------
14728
14729A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14730not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14731"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14732The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14733
14734always_false : boolean
14735 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14736 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14737
14738always_true : boolean
14739 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14740 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14741
14742avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014743 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14745 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14746 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14747 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14748 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14749 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14750 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14751 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14752 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14753 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14754 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14755 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14756 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014759 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14760 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14761 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14762 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014763 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14764
14765be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14766 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14767 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14768 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14769 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14770 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014771 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14772 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014773
14774 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14775 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14776 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14779 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14780 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14781 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014782 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14784 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014785
14786 Example :
14787 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14788 backend dynamic
14789 mode http
14790 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14791 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014793bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014794 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14795 of the string.
14796
14797bool(<bool>) : bool
14798 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14799 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14802 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014803 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14805 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014806
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014807 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014808 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014809 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14810
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014811 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14812 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014813
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014814 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014815 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014817 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014818 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014820 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014821
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014822 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14823 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014825 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014826
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014827cpu_calls : integer
14828 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14829 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14830 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14831 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14832 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14833 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14834
14835cpu_ns_avg : integer
14836 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14837 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14838 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14839 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14840 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14841 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14842 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14843 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14844 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14845 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14846 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14847
14848cpu_ns_tot : integer
14849 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14850 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14851 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14852 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14853 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14854 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14855 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14856 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14857 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14858 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14859 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14860 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14861 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14862
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014863date([<offset>]) : integer
14864 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14865 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14866 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14867 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014868 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14869
14870 Example :
14871
14872 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14873 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014874
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014875date_us : integer
14876 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14877 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14878 from the same timeval structure.
14879
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014880distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14881 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14882 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14883 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14884 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14885 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14886 list of supported tokens.
14887
14888distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14889 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14890 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14891 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14892 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14893 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14894 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14895 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14896 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14897 supported tokens.
14898
14899 Example :
14900 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14901 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14902 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14903 # send large files to the big farm
14904 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14905
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014906env(<name>) : string
14907 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14908 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14909 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14910 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14911 certain way.
14912
14913 Examples :
14914 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14915 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14916
14917 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14918 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14921 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014922 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14923 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14925 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014926 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14928 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014929
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014930fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14932 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14933 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14936 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14937 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14938 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14939 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14940 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14941 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14942 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14943 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014944
14945 Example :
14946 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14947 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14948 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14949 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14950 frontend mail
14951 bind :25
14952 mode tcp
14953 maxconn 100
14954 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14955 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14956 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14957 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014958
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014959hostname : string
14960 Returns the system hostname.
14961
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014962int(<integer>) : signed integer
14963 Returns a signed integer.
14964
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014965ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14966 Returns an ipv4.
14967
14968ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14969 Returns an ipv6.
14970
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014971lat_ns_avg : integer
14972 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14973 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14974 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14975 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14976 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14977 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14978 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14979 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14980 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14981 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14982 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14983 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14984 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14985 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14986
14987lat_ns_tot : integer
14988 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14989 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14990 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14991 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14992 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14993 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14994 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14995 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14996 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14997 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14998 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14999 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15000 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15001 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15002 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15003 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15004 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15005 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15006 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15007
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015008meth(<method>) : method
15009 Returns a method.
15010
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015011nbproc : integer
15012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15013 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15014 and debugging purposes.
15015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015016nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15018 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15019 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015020 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15021 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15022 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015023
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015024prio_class : integer
15025 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15026 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15027 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15028
15029prio_offset : integer
15030 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15031 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15032 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15033 set-priority-offset".
15034
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015035proc : integer
15036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15037 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15038 debugging purposes.
15039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015041 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15042 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15043 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15045 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15046 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15047 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15048 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15049
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015050rand([<range>]) : integer
15051 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15052 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15053 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15054 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15055 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15056
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015057uuid([<version>]) : string
15058 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15059 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15060 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15063 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15064 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15065 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15066 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15067 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015068 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15069 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15070
15071srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15072 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15073 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15074 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15075 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15076 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15077 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15078 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15079
15080 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15081 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082
15083srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15084 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15085 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15086 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015087 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15089 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15090 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15091
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015092srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15094 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15095 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15096 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15097 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15098 fetch methods.
15099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15101 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15102 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015103 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15105 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015106 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107 overloading servers).
15108
15109 Example :
15110 # Redirect to a separate back
15111 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15112 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15113 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15114
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015115stopping : boolean
15116 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15117 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15118 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15119
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015120str(<string>) : string
15121 Returns a string.
15122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15124 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15125 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15126
15127table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15128 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15129 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15130 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15131
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015132thread : integer
15133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15134 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15135 and debugging purposes.
15136
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015137var(<var-name>) : undefined
15138 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015139 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15140 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015141 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015142 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15143 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015144 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015145 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15146 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015147 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015148 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015149
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151507.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151----------------------------------
15152
15153The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15154closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15155methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15156sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15157TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015158the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15159counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015160"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15161used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15162can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15163Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15164table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15165tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15166currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015168bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015169 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15170 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15171 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173be_id : integer
15174 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15175 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15176
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015177be_name : string
15178 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15179 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181dst : ip
15182 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15183 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15184 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15185 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015186 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15187 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15188 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15189 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15190 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15191 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192
15193dst_conn : integer
15194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15195 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15196 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15197 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15198 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15199 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15200 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15201 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015202
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015203dst_is_local : boolean
15204 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15205 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15206 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15207 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015208 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015209 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15210 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15211 it only once per connection.
15212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213dst_port : integer
15214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15215 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15216 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15217 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15218 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15219 an HTTP header.
15220
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015221fc_http_major : integer
15222 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15223 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15224 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15225
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015226fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15227 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15228 header.
15229
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015230fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15231 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15232 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15233 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15234 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15235 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15236 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15237
15238fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15239 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15240 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15241 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15242 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15243 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15244 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15245
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015246fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015247 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15248 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15249 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15250 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15251
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015252fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015253 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15254 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15255 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15256 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15257
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015258fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015259 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15260 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15261 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15262 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15263
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015264fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015265 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15266 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15267 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15268 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15269
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015270fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015271 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15272 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15273 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15274 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15275
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015276fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015277 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15278 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15279 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15280 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15281
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015282fe_defbe : string
15283 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15284 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286fe_id : integer
15287 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015288 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15290
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015291fe_name : string
15292 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15293 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15294 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15295
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015296sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015297sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15298sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15299sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015300 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15301 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15302 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15303
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015304sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015305sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15306sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15307sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015308 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15309 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15310 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15311
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015312sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015313sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15314sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15315sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015316 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15317 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015318 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15319 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15320 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015321
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015322 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015323 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15324 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015325 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15326 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15327 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015328 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15329 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15330
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015331sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15332sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15333sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15334sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15335 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15336 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15337 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15338 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15339 when a first ACL was verified.
15340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015341sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015342sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15343sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15344sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015345 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015346 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15347
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015348sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015349sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15350sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15351sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015352 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15353 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15354 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15355
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015356sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015357sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15358sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15359sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015360 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15361 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15362 See also src_conn_rate.
15363
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015364sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015365sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15366sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15367sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015368 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015369 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015370
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015371sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15372sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15373sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15374sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15375 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15376 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15377
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015378sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15379sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15380sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15381sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15382 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15383 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015385sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015386sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15387sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15388sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015389 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15390 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15391 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015392 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15393 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15394 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015395
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015396sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15397sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15398sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15399sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15400 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15401 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15402 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15403 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15404 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15405 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15406
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015407sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015408sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15409sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15410sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015411 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015412 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15413 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15414
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015415sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015416sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15417sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15418sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015419 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15420 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15421 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15422 src_http_err_rate.
15423
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015424sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015425sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15426sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15427sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015428 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015429 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15430 src_http_req_cnt.
15431
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015432sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015433sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15434sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15435sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015436 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15437 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15438 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15439 src_http_req_rate.
15440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015441sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015442sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15443sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15444sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015445 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015446 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15447 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15448 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15449 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015451 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015452 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15453 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015454 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15455
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015456sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15457sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15458sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15459sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15460 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15461 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15462 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15463 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15464 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015466sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015467sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15468sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15469sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015470 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15471 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15472 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015474sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015475sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15476sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15477sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015478 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15479 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15480 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015482sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015483sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15484sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15485sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015486 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015487 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15488 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15489 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015490 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015491 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15492
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015493sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015494sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15495sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15496sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015497 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15498 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15499 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15500 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15501 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015502 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015503
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015504sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015505sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15506sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15507sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015508 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15509 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15510 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15511
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015512sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015513sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15514sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15515sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015516 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15517 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015518 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015519 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15520 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15522 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15523 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525so_id : integer
15526 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15527 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15528 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015529
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015530so_name : string
15531 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15532 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15533 strings instead of integers.
15534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015536 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15538 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15539 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015540 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15541 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15542 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015543 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15544 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15545 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15546 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15547 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15548 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15549 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015550
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015551 Example:
15552 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15553 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15556 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15557 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15558 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015559 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15562 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15563 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015565 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15568 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15569 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15570 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15571 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15572 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15573 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015574
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015575 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015576 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15577 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15578 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15579 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015580 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015581 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15582 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15583
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015584src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15585 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15586 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15587 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15588 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15589 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15590 was verified.
15591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015593 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015595 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015596 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015599 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15601 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015602 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15605 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15606 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15607 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015608 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015611 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015613 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015614 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015616src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15617 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15618 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15619 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15620 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15621
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015622src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15624 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15625 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15626 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015629 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15632 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015633 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15634 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15635 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015636
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015637src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15638 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15639 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15640 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15641 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15642 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15643 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15644 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015647 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015649 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015650 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15654 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15655 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15656 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15657 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015658 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015661 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15663 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015664 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15667 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15668 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15669 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015670 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015671 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15674 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15675 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15676 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015677 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15679 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015680
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015681 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015682 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015683 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015684 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015685
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015686src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15687 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15688 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15689 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15690 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15691 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15692 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15693
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015694src_is_local : boolean
15695 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15696 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15697 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15698 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015699 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015700 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15701 once per connection.
15702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015704 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15705 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15706 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15707 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15708 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015711 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15712 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15713 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15714 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15715 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717src_port : integer
15718 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15719 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15720 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15721 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015724 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015725 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15726 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15727 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015728 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15731 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15732 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15733 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15734 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015735 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15738 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15739 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15740 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15741 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15742 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15743 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15744 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15745 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015746
15747 Example :
15748 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15749 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15750 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15751 listen ssh
15752 bind :22
15753 mode tcp
15754 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015755 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015757 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759srv_id : integer
15760 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15761 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15762 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157647.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15768closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15769when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15770usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015771future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015772
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001577351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15774 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15775 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15776 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15777 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15778 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15779
15780 Example :
15781 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15782 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15783 # the request.
15784 frontend http-in
15785 bind *:8081
15786 default_backend servers
15787 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15788 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15789
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015790ssl_bc : boolean
15791 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15792 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15793 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15794
15795ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15796 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15797 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15798
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015799ssl_bc_alpn : string
15800 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15801 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015802 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015803 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15804 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15805 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15806 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15807 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15808 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15809
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015810ssl_bc_cipher : string
15811 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15812 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15813
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015814ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15815 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15816 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15817 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15818
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015819ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15820 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15821 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15822 session or a TLS ticket.
15823
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015824ssl_bc_npn : string
15825 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15826 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015827 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015828 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15829 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15830 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15831 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15832 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15833
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015834ssl_bc_protocol : string
15835 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15836 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15837
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015838ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015839 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015840 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15841 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015842
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015843ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15844 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15845 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15846 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15847
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015848ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15849 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15850 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15851 if session was reused or not.
15852
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015853ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15854 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15855 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15856 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15857 BoringSSL.
15858
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015859ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15860 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15861 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15865 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15866 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15867 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15868 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15871 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15872 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15873 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15874 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015875
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015876ssl_c_der : binary
15877 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_c_err : integer
15882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15883 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15884 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15885 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15886 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15890 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15891 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15892 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15893 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15894 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15895 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15896 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898ssl_c_key_alg : string
15899 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15900 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15901 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903ssl_c_notafter : string
15904 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15905 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15906 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908ssl_c_notbefore : string
15909 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15910 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15911 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15914 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15915 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15916 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15917 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15918 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15919 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15920 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15921 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923ssl_c_serial : binary
15924 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15925 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15926 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15929 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15930 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15931 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015932 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15933 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15934
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015935 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015936 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15939 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15940 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15941 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943ssl_c_used : boolean
15944 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15945 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947ssl_c_verify : integer
15948 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15949 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15950 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15951 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953ssl_c_version : integer
15954 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15955 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015956
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015957ssl_f_der : binary
15958 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15959 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15960 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15963 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15964 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15965 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15966 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015967 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15969 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15970 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972ssl_f_key_alg : string
15973 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15974 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15975 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977ssl_f_notafter : string
15978 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15979 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15980 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982ssl_f_notbefore : string
15983 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15984 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15985 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15988 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15989 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15990 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15991 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15992 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15993 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15994 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15995 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997ssl_f_serial : binary
15998 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15999 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16000 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016001
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016002ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16003 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16004 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16005 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16008 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16009 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16010 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012ssl_f_version : integer
16013 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16014 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16015
16016ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016017 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16018 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16019 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021 Example :
16022 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16023 listen http-https
16024 bind :80
16025 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16026 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16027
16028ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16029 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16030 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16031
16032ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016033 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16035 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16036 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16037 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16038 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16039 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16040 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16041 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043ssl_fc_cipher : string
16044 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16045 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016046
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016047ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16048 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16049 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016050 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016051
16052ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16053 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16054 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016055 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016056
16057ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16058 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16059 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16060 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016061 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016062 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016063
16064ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16065 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16066 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016067 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016068
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016069ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16070 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16071 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16072 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016075 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16076 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016077 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16078 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16079 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16080 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016081
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016082ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16083 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16084 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16085 wait until the handshake happened.
16086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16088 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016089 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16090 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016091 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016092 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016093
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016094ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016095 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016096 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16097 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016100 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16102 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16103 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16104 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16105 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16106 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16107 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109ssl_fc_protocol : string
16110 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16111 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016112
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016113ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016114 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016115 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16116 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016117
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016118ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16119 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16120 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16121 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16124 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16125 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16126 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16127 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016128
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016129ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16130 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16131 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16132 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16133 BoringSSL.
16134
16135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136ssl_fc_sni : string
16137 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16138 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16139 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16140 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16141 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16142
16143 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16144 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16145 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016146 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016147 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16151 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16154 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16155 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016156
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016157
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161587.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16162sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16163only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16164For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16165be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16166can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16167sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16168for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16169content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016172 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16174 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16177 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016178 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181req.len : integer
16182req_len : integer (deprecated)
16183 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16184 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16185 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16186 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16187 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16188 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16189 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16190 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16193 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016194 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16195 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16196 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16197 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 ACL alternatives :
16200 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16203 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16204 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16205 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16206 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 ACL alternatives :
16209 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213req.proto_http : boolean
16214req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16215 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16216 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16217 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16218 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16219 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16220 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16221 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223 Example:
16224 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16225 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16226 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016227 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16230rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16231 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16232 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16233 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16234 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16235 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16236 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16237 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16240 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16241 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16242 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16243 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16244 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 ACL derivatives :
16247 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 Example :
16250 listen tse-farm
16251 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16252 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16253 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16254 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16255 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16256 persist rdp-cookie
16257 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16258 # This is only useful makes sense if
16259 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16260 stick-table type string size 204800
16261 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16262 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16263 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016265 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16266 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16269rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16270 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16271 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16272 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16273 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 ACL derivatives :
16276 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016277
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016278req.ssl_alpn : string
16279 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16280 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16281 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16282 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16283 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16284 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016285 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016286
16287 Examples :
16288 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16289 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16290 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016291 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016292 default_backend bk_default
16293
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016294req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16295 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16296 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016297 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16298 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16299 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16300 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16301 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16304req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16305 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16306 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16307 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16308 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16309 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16310 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16311 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313req.ssl_sni : string
16314req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16315 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16316 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16317 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16318 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16319 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16320 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16321 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16322 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16323 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16324 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16325 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16326 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016328 ACL derivatives :
16329 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331 Examples :
16332 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16333 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16334 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16335 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16336 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016337
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016338req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16339 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16340 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16341 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16342 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16343 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16344 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16345 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16346 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16347 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349req.ssl_ver : integer
16350req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16351 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16352 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16353 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16354 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16355 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16356 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16357 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016358 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361 ACL derivatives :
16362 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016363
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016364res.len : integer
16365 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16366 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16367 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16368 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16369 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16370 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16371 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16372 content inspection.
16373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16375 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016376 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16377 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16378 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16379 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16382 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16383 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16384 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16385 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016388
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016389res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16390rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16391 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16392 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16393 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16394 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16395 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16396 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16397 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016399wait_end : boolean
16400 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16401 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016402 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16404 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016405 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16407 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 Examples :
16410 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16411 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16412 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16415 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16416 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16417 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16418 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16419 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16420 tcp-request content reject
16421
16422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424--------------------------------------
16425
16426It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16427This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16428data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16429its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16430HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16431content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16432to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16433more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16434response are indexed.
16435
16436base : string
16437 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16438 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16439 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16440 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16441 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16442 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16443 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16444 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16445
16446 ACL derivatives :
16447 base : exact string match
16448 base_beg : prefix match
16449 base_dir : subdir match
16450 base_dom : domain match
16451 base_end : suffix match
16452 base_len : length match
16453 base_reg : regex match
16454 base_sub : substring match
16455
16456base32 : integer
16457 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16458 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16459 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016460 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16461 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16462 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463
16464base32+src : binary
16465 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16466 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16467 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16468 per-URL counters.
16469
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016470capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16471 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16472 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16473 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16474
16475capture.req.method : string
16476 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16477 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16478 because it's allocated.
16479
16480capture.req.uri : string
16481 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16482 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16483 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16484 allocated.
16485
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016486capture.req.ver : string
16487 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16488 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16489 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16490
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016491capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16492 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16493 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16494 The first entry is an index of 0.
16495 See also: "capture response header"
16496
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016497capture.res.ver : string
16498 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16499 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16500 persistent flag.
16501
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016502req.body : binary
16503 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16504 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16505 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16506 the first chunk is analyzed.
16507
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016508req.body_param([<name>) : string
16509 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16510 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16511 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16512 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16513 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16514 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16515 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16516 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16517 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16518 given.
16519
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016520req.body_len : integer
16521 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16522 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16523 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16524 "option http-buffer-request".
16525
16526req.body_size : integer
16527 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16528 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16529 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16530 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16531 "option http-buffer-request".
16532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016533req.cook([<name>]) : string
16534cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16535 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16536 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16537 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16538 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16539 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16540 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16541 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16542 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16543
16544 ACL derivatives :
16545 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16546 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16547 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16548 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16549 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16550 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16551 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16552 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16555cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16556 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16557 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16560cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16561 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16562 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16563 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16564 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16568 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16569 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16570 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016571 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16573 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16574 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16575 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016577hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16578 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16579 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16580 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16581 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016582 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16585 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16586 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16587 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16588 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16589 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16590 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16591 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16592 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16595 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16596 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16597 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16598 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16601 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16602 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16603 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16604 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16605 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16606 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16607 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16608 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016609 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016611 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016613 ACL derivatives :
16614 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16615 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16616 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16617 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16618 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16619 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16620 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16621 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16622
16623req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16624hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16625 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16626 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16627 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16628 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16629 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16630 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16631 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16632 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16633 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16634
16635req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16636hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16637 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16638 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16639 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16640 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16641 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016642 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16644 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16645
16646req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16647hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16648 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16649 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16650 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16651 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16652 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16653 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16654 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16655
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016656req.hdrs : string
16657 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16658 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16659 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16660 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16661
16662req.hdrs_bin : binary
16663 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16664 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16665 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16666 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16667 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16668 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16669
16670 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016671
Christopher Faulet5be59a92020-11-24 17:13:24 +010016672 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16673 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16676 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16677 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16678 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16679 basic auth is supported.
16680
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016681http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16682 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16683 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16684 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16685 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16687 basic auth is supported.
16688
16689 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016690 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16691 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16692 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16693 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694
16695http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016696 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16697 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16699 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701method : integer + string
16702 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16703 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16704 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16705 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16706 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16707 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16708 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016710 ACL derivatives :
16711 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016713 Example :
16714 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16715 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16716 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016718path : string
16719 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16720 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16721 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16722 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16723 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016724 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016727 ACL derivatives :
16728 path : exact string match
16729 path_beg : prefix match
16730 path_dir : subdir match
16731 path_dom : domain match
16732 path_end : suffix match
16733 path_len : length match
16734 path_reg : regex match
16735 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016736
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016737query : string
16738 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16739 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16740 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16741 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016742 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016743 which stops before the question mark.
16744
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016745req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16746 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16747 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16748 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16749 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751req.ver : string
16752req_ver : string (deprecated)
16753 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16754 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16755 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757 ACL derivatives :
16758 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760res.comp : boolean
16761 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16762 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16763 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016765res.comp_algo : string
16766 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16767 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16768 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770res.cook([<name>]) : string
16771scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16772 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16773 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16774 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 ACL derivatives :
16777 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016779res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16780scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16781 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16782 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16783 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016785res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16786scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16787 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16788 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16789 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016791res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16792 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16793 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16794 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16795 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16796 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16797 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16798 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16799 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16800 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16803 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16804 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16805 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16806 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16807 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016809res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16810shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16811 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16812 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16813 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16814 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16815 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16816 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16817 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16818 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820 ACL derivatives :
16821 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16822 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16823 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16824 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16825 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16826 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16827 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16828 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16829
16830res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16831shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16832 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16833 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16834 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16835 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16836 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016838res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16839shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16840 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16841 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16842 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16843 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16844 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16845 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016846
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016847res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16848 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16849 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16850 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16851 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016853res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16854shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16855 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16856 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16857 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16858 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16859 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16860 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862res.ver : string
16863resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16864 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16865 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867 ACL derivatives :
16868 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16871 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16872 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016873 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16877 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879status : integer
16880 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16881 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16882 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016883
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016884unique-id : string
16885 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16886 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16887 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16888 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16889 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16890 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892url : string
16893 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16894 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16895 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16896 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16897 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16898 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16899 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901 ACL derivatives :
16902 url : exact string match
16903 url_beg : prefix match
16904 url_dir : subdir match
16905 url_dom : domain match
16906 url_end : suffix match
16907 url_len : length match
16908 url_reg : regex match
16909 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911url_ip : ip
16912 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16913 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16914 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16915 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16916 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16917 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16918 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920url_port : integer
16921 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16922 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16923 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16924 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016925
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016926urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16927url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16929 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016930 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16931 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16932 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16933 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16935 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016936 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16937 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939 ACL derivatives :
16940 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16941 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16942 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16943 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16944 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16945 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16946 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16947 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016948
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016950 Example :
16951 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16952 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16953 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16954 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016955
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016956urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016957 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16958 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16959 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016960
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016961url32 : integer
16962 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16963 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16964 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16965 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16966 is an unsigned integer.
16967
16968url32+src : binary
16969 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16970 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16971 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16972
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169747.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016975---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016977Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16978every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016979order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016981ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16982---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016983FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016984HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016985HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16986HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016987HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16988HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16989HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16990HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16991LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016992METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016993METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016994METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16995METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16996METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16997METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016998METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016999METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017000RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017001REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017002TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017003WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17004---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017005
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170078. Logging
17008----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017009
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017010One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17011provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17012very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17013provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17014state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017015to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017016headers.
17017
17018In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17019about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17020send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17021
17022 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17023 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17024 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17025 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17026 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017027 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017028 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017029
17030The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17031allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17032as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17033while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17034real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17035delay.
17036
17037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170388.1. Log levels
17039---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017041TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017043HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17044in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17045track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17046syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17047about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017048
17049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170508.2. Log formats
17051----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017053HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017054and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17055slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17056options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017057
17058 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17059 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17060 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17061 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17062 extents.
17063
17064 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17065 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17066 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17067 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17068 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17069
17070 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17071 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17072 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17073 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17074 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17075
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017076 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17077 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17078 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17079 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17080
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017081 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17082
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17084specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17085field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17086servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17087always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17088identifier.
17089
17090Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17091 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17092 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17093 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17094 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17095
17096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170978.2.1. Default log format
17098-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099
17100This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17101as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17102format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17103
17104 Example :
17105 listen www
17106 mode http
17107 log global
17108 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17109
17110 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17111 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17112 (www/HTTP)
17113
17114 Field Format Extract from the example above
17115 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17116 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17117 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17118 4 'to' to
17119 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17120 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17121
17122Detailed fields description :
17123 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17124 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17125 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17126 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17127 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17128 and processed the connection.
17129 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17130
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017131In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17132"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17133connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17134
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017135It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17136will eventually disappear.
17137
17138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171398.2.2. TCP log format
17140---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017141
17142The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17143is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17144information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17145counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17146emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17147environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17148the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17149sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017150specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17151not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17152fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17153marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
17155 Example :
17156 frontend fnt
17157 mode tcp
17158 option tcplog
17159 log global
17160 default_backend bck
17161
17162 backend bck
17163 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17164
17165 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17166 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17167 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17168
17169 Field Format Extract from the example above
17170 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17171 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17172 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17173 4 frontend_name fnt
17174 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17175 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17176 7 bytes_read* 212
17177 8 termination_state --
17178 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17179 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17180
17181Detailed fields description :
17182 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017183 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17184 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17185 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017186 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017187 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017188 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017189
17190 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017191 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17192 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17193 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194
17195 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17196 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17197 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017198 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17199 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17200 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17201 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017202
17203 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17204 and processed the connection.
17205
17206 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17207 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17208 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17209 applications.
17210
17211 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17212 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17213 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17214 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17215 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17216
17217 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17218 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17219 See "Timers" below for more details.
17220
17221 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17222 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17223 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17224 "Timers" below for more details.
17225
17226 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017227 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17229 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17230 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17231 details.
17232
17233 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17234 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17235 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17236 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17237 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17238
17239 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17240 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17241 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17242 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17243 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17244 for more details.
17245
17246 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017247 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17249 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17250 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017251 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017252
17253 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17254 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17255 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17256 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17257 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17258 caused by a denial of service attack.
17259
17260 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17261 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17262 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17263 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17264 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17265 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17266 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17267 denial of service attack.
17268
17269 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17270 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17271 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17272 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17273 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17274 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17275 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17276 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17277 be processed than on other servers.
17278
17279 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17280 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17281 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17282 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17283 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17284 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17285 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17286 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17287 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17288 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17289 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17290 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17291 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17292
17293 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17294 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17295 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17296 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17297 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17298 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017299 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17301
17302 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17303 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17304 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17305 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17306 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17307 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017308 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017309 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17310 occurs.
17311
17312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173138.2.3. HTTP log format
17314----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315
17316The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17317is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17318the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17319are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17320emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17321generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17322"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17323which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017324frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17325is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017326
17327Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17328slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17329with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17330
17331 Example :
17332 frontend http-in
17333 mode http
17334 option httplog
17335 log global
17336 default_backend bck
17337
17338 backend static
17339 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17340
17341 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17342 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17343 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017344 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017345
17346 Field Format Extract from the example above
17347 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17348 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017349 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 4 frontend_name http-in
17351 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017352 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353 7 status_code 200
17354 8 bytes_read* 2750
17355 9 captured_request_cookie -
17356 10 captured_response_cookie -
17357 11 termination_state ----
17358 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17359 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17360 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17361 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17362 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017363
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364Detailed fields description :
17365 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017366 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17367 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17368 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017369 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017370 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017371 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372
17373 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017374 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17375 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17376 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017378 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17379 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380
17381 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17382 and processed the connection.
17383
17384 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17385 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17386 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17387
17388 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17389 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17390 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17391 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17392 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17393 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17394
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017395 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17396 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17397 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017398 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017399 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17400 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017401 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17402 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403
17404 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17405 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017406 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017407
17408 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17409 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017410 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17411 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017412
17413 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17414 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17415 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17416 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17417 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017418 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17419 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017420
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017421 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17422 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17423 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17424 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17425 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17426 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17427 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017428 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017429
17430 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17431 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17432 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17433
17434 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17435 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017436 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17438 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17439 overflowing.
17440
17441 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17442 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17443 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17444 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17445 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17446 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17447 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17448 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17449
17450 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17451 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17452 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17453 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17454 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17455 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17456 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17457 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17458
17459 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17460 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17461 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17462 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17463 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17464 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17465 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17466
17467 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017468 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17470 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17471 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017472 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017473 system.
17474
17475 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17476 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17477 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17478 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17479 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17480 caused by a denial of service attack.
17481
17482 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17483 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17484 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17485 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17486 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17487 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17488 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17489 denial of service attack.
17490
17491 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17492 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17493 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17494 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17495 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17496 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17497 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17498 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17499 processed than on other servers.
17500
17501 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17502 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17503 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17504 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17505 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17506 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17507 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17508 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17509 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17510 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17511 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17512 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17513 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17514
17515 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17516 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17517 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17518 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17519 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17520 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017521 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17523
17524 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17525 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17526 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17527 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17528 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17529 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017530 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17532 occurs.
17533
17534 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17535 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17536 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17537 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17538 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17539 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17540 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17541 cookies" below for more details.
17542
17543 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17544 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17545 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17546 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17547 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17548 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17549 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17550 and cookies" below for more details.
17551
17552 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17553 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17554 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17555 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17556 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17557 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17558 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17559 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17560
17561
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175628.2.4. Custom log format
17563------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017564
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017565The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017566mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017568HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017569Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17570separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17571prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17572
17573Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17574variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017575("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017576
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017577If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017578as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017579less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17580the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17581
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017582Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017583In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017584in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017585
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017586Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17587'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17588https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17589such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17590
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017591Flags are :
17592 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017593 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017594 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17595 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017596
17597 Example:
17598
17599 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17600 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17601
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017602 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17603
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017604At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17605
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017606 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17607 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017608
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017609the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017610
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017611 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17612 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17613 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017614
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017615and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17616
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017617 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17618 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017619
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017620Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17621
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017622 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017623 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017624 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17625 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17626 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017627 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17628 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17629 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017630 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017631 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17632 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017633 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017634 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17635 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017636 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017637 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017638 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017639 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017640 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017641 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017642 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017643 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17644 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17645 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17646 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17647 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017648 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017649 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17650 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017651 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017652 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17653 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017654 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17655 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17656 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017657 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017658 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17659 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017660 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017661 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17662 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17663 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017664 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017665 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017666 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17667 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17668 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17669 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017670 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017671 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017672 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017673 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017674 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017675 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017676 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17677 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17678 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017679 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017680 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17681 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017682 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017683 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17684 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017685 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017686 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017687 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017688 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017689
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017690 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017691
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017692
176938.2.5. Error log format
17694-----------------------
17695
17696When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17697protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17698By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17699"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017700will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017701logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17702
17703The format looks like this :
17704
17705 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17706 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17707 Connection error during SSL handshake
17708
17709 Field Format Extract from the example above
17710 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17711 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17712 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17713 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17714 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17715
17716These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17717failures.
17718
17719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177208.3. Advanced logging options
17721-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017722
17723Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17724just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17725options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17726for more information about their usage.
17727
17728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17730------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731
17732It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17733haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17734commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17735monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17736ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17737
17738 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17739 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17740 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17741 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17742
17743 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17744 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17745 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017746 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017747 such as other load-balancers.
17748
17749 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17750 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17751 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17752
17753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177548.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17755----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017756
17757The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17758what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17759or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017760"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17762log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17763after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17764is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17765with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17766with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17767
17768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177698.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17770------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017771
17772Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17773for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17774"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17775retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17776raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17777a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17778file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17779you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17780"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17781
17782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17784--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017785
17786Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17787multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17788them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17789"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17790logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17791error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17792and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17793too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17794useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17795alternative.
17796
17797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177988.4. Timing events
17799------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800
17801Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17802reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17803the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17804frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017805mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17806addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17807
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017808Timings events in HTTP mode:
17809
17810 first request 2nd request
17811 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17812 t tr t tr ...
17813 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17814 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17815 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17816 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17817 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17818
17819Timings events in TCP mode:
17820
17821 TCP session
17822 |<----------------->|
17823 t t
17824 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17825 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17826 |<------ Tt ------->|
17827
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017828 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017829 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017830 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17831 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17832 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017833 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017834 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17835 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17836 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17837 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017838
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017839 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17840 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17841 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017842 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17843 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17844 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17845 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17846 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17847 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017848
17849 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17850 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17851 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17852 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17853 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17854 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17855 request typed by hand during a test.
17856
17857 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17858 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017859 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017860 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17861 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17862 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17863 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864
17865 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17866 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17867 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17868 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17869 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17870
17871 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17872 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17873 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17874 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17875 connection never established.
17876
17877 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17878 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17879 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17880 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17881 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17882 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17883 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17884 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17885 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17886 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17887 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17888
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017889 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17890 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17891 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17892 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17893 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17894 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17895
17896 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17897
17898 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17899 "Ta" can never be negative.
17900
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017901 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17902 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017903 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17904 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017905 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017906
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017907 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908
17909 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017910 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17911 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017912
17913These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17914protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17915that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017916due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17917"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17918that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017919
17920Most common cases :
17921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017922 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17923 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17924 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17925 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17926 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17927 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17928 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17929 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17930 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17931 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17932 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017933 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934
17935 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17936 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17937 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17938 of ms on remote networks.
17939
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017940 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17941 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17942 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017944 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17945 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17946 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17947 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17948 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17949 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17950 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17951 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17952 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953
17954Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017956 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017957 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017958 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017959
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017960 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017961 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17962 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17963
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017964 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017965 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17966 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17967 flags.
17968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017969 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17970 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17972 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17973 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17974 the client connection was maintained open.
17975
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017976 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017977 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017978 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17980
17981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179828.5. Session state at disconnection
17983-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
17985TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17986"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17988each of which has a special meaning :
17989
17990 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17991 session to terminate :
17992
17993 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17994
17995 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17996 server explicitly refused it.
17997
17998 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17999 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18000 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18001 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018002 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018003
18004 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18005 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006
18007 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18008 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18009 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18010 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18011 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18012
18013 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18014 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18015 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18016 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18017 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18018
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018019 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18020 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18021
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018022 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18023 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18024 backup connections when going up.
18025
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018026 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018028 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18029 send or receive data.
18030
18031 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18032 send or receive data.
18033
18034 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18035 with nothing left in the buffers.
18036
18037 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18038
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018039 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18041
18042 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18043 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18044 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18045 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18046 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18047
18048 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18049 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18050
18051 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18052 server (HTTP only).
18053
18054 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18055
18056 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18057 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18058 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18059
18060 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18061 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18062 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18063
18064 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18065
18066 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18067 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18068
18069 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18070 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18071 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18072
18073 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18074 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018075 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18076 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077
18078 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18079 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18080 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18081 another server.
18082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018083 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018084 server.
18085
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018086 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18087 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18088 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18089 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18090
18091 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18092 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18093 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18094 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18095
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018096 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18097 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18098 "use-server" rule).
18099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018100 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18101
18102 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18103 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18104
18105 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18106
18107 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18108 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18109 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18110
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018111 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18112 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018113 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018114 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18115 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18118
18119 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18120 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18121
18122 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18123
18124 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18125
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018126The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18127was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018128helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18129starvation, attacks, etc...
18130
18131The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18132alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18133easier finding and understanding.
18134
18135 Flags Reason
18136
18137 -- Normal termination.
18138
18139 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18140 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18141 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18142 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18143
18144 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18145 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18146 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18147 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18148 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18149 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018150
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18152 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018153 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018154
18155 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18156 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18157 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18158
18159 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18160 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18161 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18162 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18163 the server takes too long to respond.
18164
18165 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18166 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18167 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18168 long a time to respond.
18169
18170 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18171 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18172 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18173 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018174 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18175 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018176
18177 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18178 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18179 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18180 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18181 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018182 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018183 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18184 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18185 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18186 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18187 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18188 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18189 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18190 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018191 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018192 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18193 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18194 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018195
18196 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18197 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018198 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18199 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18200 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18201 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018202
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018203 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18204 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018206 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18208 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018209 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018210 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18211 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18212
18213 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18214 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18215 503 or 504 here.
18216
18217 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18218 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18219 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18220 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18221 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18222
18223 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18224 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018225 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018226 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18227 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18228
18229 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18230 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18231 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18232 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18233 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18234 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18235 between haproxy and the server.
18236
18237 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18238 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18239 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18240 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18241 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18242 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18243 solution is to fix the application.
18244
18245 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18246 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18247 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18248 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18249 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18250 external attacks.
18251
18252 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombs31d31f92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070018253 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018254 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018255 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18256 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18257
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018258 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18259 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18260 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018261 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018262 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018264 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18265 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18266 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18267 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018268 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18269 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18270 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18271 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18272 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018273
18274 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18275 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18276 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18277 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18278
18279 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18280 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18281 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18282 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18283
18284 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18285 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18286 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18287 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18288
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018289The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18290persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18291important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18292re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18293
18294 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18295
18296 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18297 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18298 set on a GET request.
18299
18300 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18301 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018302 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018303 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18304
18305 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18306 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18307 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18308
18309 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18310 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18311 already got a cookie.
18312
18313 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18314 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18315 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18316 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18317 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18318
18319 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18320 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18321 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18322
18323 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18324 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18325 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18326
18327 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18328 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18329
18330 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18331 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18332 then advertised in the response.
18333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183358.6. Non-printable characters
18336-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018337
18338In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18339consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18340converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18341prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18342being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18343escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18344is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18345'}' when logging headers.
18346
18347Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18348issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18349containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18350
18351Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18352the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18353performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18354
18355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183568.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18357---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018358
18359Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18360achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018361section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018362cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18363the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18364the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018365locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018366not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18367user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18368a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18369wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18370
18371 Examples :
18372 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18373 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18374
18375 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18376 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18377
18378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183798.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18380---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018381
18382Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18383proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18384the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18385server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18386
18387Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18388response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018389section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018390
18391It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018392time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18393appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018394are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18395and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18396follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18397request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18398in the logs.
18399
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018400As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18401frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18402an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18403
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018404 Example :
18405 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18406 listen proxy-out
18407 mode http
18408 option httplog
18409 option logasap
18410 log global
18411 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18412
18413 # log the name of the virtual server
18414 capture request header Host len 20
18415
18416 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18417 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18418
18419 # log the beginning of the referrer
18420 capture request header Referer len 20
18421
18422 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18423 capture response header Server len 20
18424
18425 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18426 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18427
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018428 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018429 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18430
18431 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18432 capture response header Via len 20
18433
18434 # log the URL location during a redirection
18435 capture response header Location len 20
18436
18437 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18438 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18439 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18440 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18441 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18442
18443 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18444 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18445 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18446 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018447 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018448
18449 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18450 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18451 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18452 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18453 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018454 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018455
18456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184578.9. Examples of logs
18458---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018459
18460These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18461them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18462reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18463
18464 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18465 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18466 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18467
18468 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18469 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18470
18471 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18472 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18473 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18474
18475 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18476 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18477
18478 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18479 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18480 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18481
18482 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018483 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018484 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18485 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18486
18487 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18488 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18489 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18490
18491 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18492 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018493 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018494 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18495 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18496 to return the 502 and not the server.
18497
18498 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018499 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018500
18501 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18502 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18503 Nothing was sent to any server.
18504
18505 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18506 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18507
18508 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18509 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018510 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018511 send a 408 return code to the client.
18512
18513 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18514 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18515
18516 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18517 5 seconds ("c----").
18518
18519 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18520 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018521 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018522
18523 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018524 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018525 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18526 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18527 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18528 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18529 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018530
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018531
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185329. Supported filters
18533--------------------
18534
18535Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18536accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18537unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18538
18539See also : "filter"
18540
185419.1. Trace
18542----------
18543
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018544filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018545
18546 Arguments:
18547 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18548 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18549
18550 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18551 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18552 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18553 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018555 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018556 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18557 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18558 amount of the parsed data.
18559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018560 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018561
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018562This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18563callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18564information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18565filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18566
18567Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18568tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18569a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18570
18571
185729.2. HTTP compression
18573---------------------
18574
18575filter compression
18576
18577The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18578keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018579when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18580it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18581response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18582line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18583cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18584the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018585
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018586See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018587
18588
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185899.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18590--------------------------------------------
18591
18592filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18593
18594 Arguments :
18595
18596 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18597 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18598 parsed.
18599
18600 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18601 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18602 part must be placed in its own scope.
18603
18604The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18605external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018606streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018607exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18608also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18609
18610SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18611the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18612
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018613For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018614"doc/SPOE.txt".
18615
18616Important note:
18617 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18618 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18619
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186209.4. Cache
18621----------
18622
18623filter cache <name>
18624
18625 Arguments :
18626
18627 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18628
18629The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18630"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018631cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018632other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18633the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18634mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18635filter other than the compression is used for the same
18636listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18637order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018638
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018639See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018640
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001864110. Cache
18642---------
18643
18644HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18645(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18646RAM.
18647
18648The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018649this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018650
18651If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18652independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18653when we try to allocate a new one.
18654
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018655The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018656
18657It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18658"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18659for more details.
18660
18661When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18662replaced by "<CACHE>".
18663
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001866410.1. Limitation
18665----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018666
18667The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18668
18669- If the response is not a 200
18670- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018671- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018672- If the response is not cacheable
18673
18674- If the request is not a GET
18675- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018676- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018677
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018678Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18679filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18680can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18681example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18682"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018683
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868410.2. Setup
18685-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018686
18687To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18688the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18689
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001869010.2.1. Cache section
18691---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018692
18693cache <name>
18694 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18695 size of cache is mandatory.
18696
18697total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018698 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018699 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018700
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018701max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018702 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18703 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18704 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018705
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018706max-age <seconds>
18707 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18708 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18709 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18710 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18711 default.
18712
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001871310.2.2. Proxy section
18714---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018715
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018716http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018717 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18718 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18719 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18720 after this one.
18721
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018722http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018723 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18724 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18725 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18726 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18727
18728
18729Example:
18730
18731 backend bck1
18732 mode http
18733
18734 http-request cache-use foobar
18735 http-response cache-store foobar
18736 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18737
18738 cache foobar
18739 total-max-size 4
18740 max-age 240
18741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018742/*
18743 * Local variables:
18744 * fill-column: 79
18745 * End:
18746 */